]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blob - gcc/dwarf2out.c
targhooks.h (default_emutls_var_fields, [...]): Declare.
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / dwarf2out.c
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2 Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
5 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
6 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
7
8 This file is part of GCC.
9
10 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
11 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
12 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
13 version.
14
15 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
16 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
17 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
18 for more details.
19
20 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
21 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
22 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
23
24 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
25 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
26 out locations for types and decls.
27 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
28 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
29
30 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
31 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
32 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
33 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
34 information. */
35
36 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
37
38 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
39 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
40 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
41 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
42 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
43
44 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
45 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
46
47 CIE = Common Information Entry
48 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
49
50 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
51
52 FDE = Frame Description Entry
53 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
54 how to restore registers
55
56 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
57 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
58
59 #include "config.h"
60 #include "system.h"
61 #include "coretypes.h"
62 #include "tm.h"
63 #include "tree.h"
64 #include "version.h"
65 #include "flags.h"
66 #include "real.h"
67 #include "rtl.h"
68 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
69 #include "regs.h"
70 #include "insn-config.h"
71 #include "reload.h"
72 #include "function.h"
73 #include "output.h"
74 #include "expr.h"
75 #include "libfuncs.h"
76 #include "except.h"
77 #include "dwarf2.h"
78 #include "dwarf2out.h"
79 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
80 #include "toplev.h"
81 #include "varray.h"
82 #include "ggc.h"
83 #include "md5.h"
84 #include "tm_p.h"
85 #include "diagnostic.h"
86 #include "debug.h"
87 #include "target.h"
88 #include "langhooks.h"
89 #include "hashtab.h"
90 #include "cgraph.h"
91 #include "input.h"
92
93 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
94 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, const char *);
95 #endif
96
97 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
98 # ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
99 # define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO \
100 (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG)
101 # else
102 # define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO 0
103 # endif
104 #endif
105
106 /* Map register numbers held in the call frame info that gcc has
107 collected using DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM to those that should be output in
108 .debug_frame and .eh_frame. */
109 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT
110 #define DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT(REGNO, FOR_EH) (REGNO)
111 #endif
112
113 /* Decide whether we want to emit frame unwind information for the current
114 translation unit. */
115
116 int
117 dwarf2out_do_frame (void)
118 {
119 /* We want to emit correct CFA location expressions or lists, so we
120 have to return true if we're going to output debug info, even if
121 we're not going to output frame or unwind info. */
122 return (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
123 || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG
124 || DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
125 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
126 || (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
127 && (flag_unwind_tables
128 || (flag_exceptions && ! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)))
129 #endif
130 );
131 }
132
133 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
134 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
135 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
136 #endif
137
138 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
139 must be kept around forever. */
140 static GTY(()) VEC(rtx,gc) *used_rtx_array;
141
142 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
143 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a
144 VEC(tree,gc) because we want to tell the garbage collector about
145 it. */
146 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *incomplete_types;
147
148 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
149 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
150 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
151 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
152 define type declaration DIE's. */
153 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *decl_scope_table;
154
155 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections. */
156 static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
157 static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
158 static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
159 static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
160 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
161 static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
162 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
163 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubtypes_section;
164 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
165 static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
166 static GTY(()) section *debug_frame_section;
167
168 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
169 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
170 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
171 #endif
172
173 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct *dw_cfi_ref;
174 typedef struct dw_fde_struct *dw_fde_ref;
175 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct *dw_cfi_oprnd_ref;
176
177 /* Call frames are described using a sequence of Call Frame
178 Information instructions. The register number, offset
179 and address fields are provided as possible operands;
180 their use is selected by the opcode field. */
181
182 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type {
183 dw_cfi_oprnd_unused,
184 dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num,
185 dw_cfi_oprnd_offset,
186 dw_cfi_oprnd_addr,
187 dw_cfi_oprnd_loc
188 };
189
190 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct GTY(())
191 {
192 unsigned int GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num"))) dw_cfi_reg_num;
193 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_offset"))) dw_cfi_offset;
194 const char * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_addr"))) dw_cfi_addr;
195 struct dw_loc_descr_struct * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_loc"))) dw_cfi_loc;
196 }
197 dw_cfi_oprnd;
198
199 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct GTY(())
200 {
201 dw_cfi_ref dw_cfi_next;
202 enum dwarf_call_frame_info dw_cfi_opc;
203 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
204 dw_cfi_oprnd1;
205 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
206 dw_cfi_oprnd2;
207 }
208 dw_cfi_node;
209
210 /* This is how we define the location of the CFA. We use to handle it
211 as REG + OFFSET all the time, but now it can be more complex.
212 It can now be either REG + CFA_OFFSET or *(REG + BASE_OFFSET) + CFA_OFFSET.
213 Instead of passing around REG and OFFSET, we pass a copy
214 of this structure. */
215 typedef struct cfa_loc GTY(())
216 {
217 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
218 HOST_WIDE_INT base_offset;
219 unsigned int reg;
220 int indirect; /* 1 if CFA is accessed via a dereference. */
221 } dw_cfa_location;
222
223 /* All call frame descriptions (FDE's) in the GCC generated DWARF
224 refer to a single Common Information Entry (CIE), defined at
225 the beginning of the .debug_frame section. This use of a single
226 CIE obviates the need to keep track of multiple CIE's
227 in the DWARF generation routines below. */
228
229 typedef struct dw_fde_struct GTY(())
230 {
231 tree decl;
232 const char *dw_fde_begin;
233 const char *dw_fde_current_label;
234 const char *dw_fde_end;
235 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_label;
236 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_end_label;
237 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_label;
238 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label;
239 bool dw_fde_switched_sections;
240 dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_cfi;
241 unsigned funcdef_number;
242 unsigned all_throwers_are_sibcalls : 1;
243 unsigned nothrow : 1;
244 unsigned uses_eh_lsda : 1;
245 }
246 dw_fde_node;
247
248 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
249 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 30
250
251 /* The size of addresses as they appear in the Dwarf 2 data.
252 Some architectures use word addresses to refer to code locations,
253 but Dwarf 2 info always uses byte addresses. On such machines,
254 Dwarf 2 addresses need to be larger than the architecture's
255 pointers. */
256 #ifndef DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
257 #define DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
258 #endif
259
260 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF field indicating an offset or length
261 relative to a debug info section, specified to be 4 bytes in the
262 DWARF-2 specification. The SGI/MIPS ABI defines it to be the same
263 as PTR_SIZE. */
264
265 #ifndef DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
266 #define DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE 4
267 #endif
268
269 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
270 should either be 4 or 12 bytes. When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
271 bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
272 bytes.
273
274 However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
275 DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE. It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly. */
276
277 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
278 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
279 #endif
280
281 #define DWARF_VERSION 2
282
283 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
284 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
285 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
286
287 /* Offsets recorded in opcodes are a multiple of this alignment factor. */
288 #ifndef DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
289 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
290 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT (-((int) UNITS_PER_WORD))
291 #else
292 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT ((int) UNITS_PER_WORD)
293 #endif
294 #endif
295
296 /* CIE identifier. */
297 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
298 #define DWARF_CIE_ID \
299 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? DW_CIE_ID : DW64_CIE_ID)
300 #else
301 #define DWARF_CIE_ID DW_CIE_ID
302 #endif
303
304 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains frame description
305 information for each routine. */
306 static GTY((length ("fde_table_allocated"))) dw_fde_ref fde_table;
307
308 /* Number of elements currently allocated for fde_table. */
309 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_allocated;
310
311 /* Number of elements in fde_table currently in use. */
312 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_in_use;
313
314 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
315 fde_table. */
316 #define FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
317
318 /* A list of call frame insns for the CIE. */
319 static GTY(()) dw_cfi_ref cie_cfi_head;
320
321 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
322 /* Some DWARF extensions (e.g., MIPS/SGI) implement a subprogram
323 attribute that accelerates the lookup of the FDE associated
324 with the subprogram. This variable holds the table index of the FDE
325 associated with the current function (body) definition. */
326 static unsigned current_funcdef_fde;
327 #endif
328
329 struct indirect_string_node GTY(())
330 {
331 const char *str;
332 unsigned int refcount;
333 unsigned int form;
334 char *label;
335 };
336
337 static GTY ((param_is (struct indirect_string_node))) htab_t debug_str_hash;
338
339 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
340 static GTY(()) unsigned long dwarf2out_cfi_label_num;
341
342 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section. */
343 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
344
345 /* Whether the default text and cold text sections have been used at all. */
346
347 static GTY(()) bool text_section_used = false;
348 static GTY(()) bool cold_text_section_used = false;
349
350 /* The default cold text section. */
351 static GTY(()) section *cold_text_section;
352
353 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
354
355 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
356
357 static char *stripattributes (const char *);
358 static const char *dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned);
359 static dw_cfi_ref new_cfi (void);
360 static void add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *, dw_cfi_ref);
361 static void add_fde_cfi (const char *, dw_cfi_ref);
362 static void lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref, dw_cfa_location *);
363 static void lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *);
364 static void reg_save (const char *, unsigned, unsigned, HOST_WIDE_INT);
365 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
366 static void initial_return_save (rtx);
367 #endif
368 static HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust_offset (const_rtx);
369 static void output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref, dw_fde_ref, int);
370 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
371 static void dwarf2out_note_section_used (void);
372 static void dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx, bool);
373 static void flush_queued_reg_saves (void);
374 static bool clobbers_queued_reg_save (const_rtx);
375 static void dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx, const char *);
376
377 /* Support for complex CFA locations. */
378 static void output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref);
379 static void get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *,
380 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *);
381 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_loc
382 (dw_cfa_location *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
383 static void def_cfa_1 (const char *, dw_cfa_location *);
384
385 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
386 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
387 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
388 #endif
389
390 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
391 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
392 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
393
394 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
395 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
396 #endif
397
398 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
399 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
400 #endif
401
402 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
403 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
404 #endif
405
406 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
407 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
408 #endif
409 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
410 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
411 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
412 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
413 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
414 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
415 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
416 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
417 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
418 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
419
420 /* The DWARF 2 CFA column which tracks the return address. Normally this
421 is the column for PC, or the first column after all of the hard
422 registers. */
423 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
424 #ifdef PC_REGNUM
425 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (PC_REGNUM)
426 #else
427 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
428 #endif
429 #endif
430
431 /* The mapping from gcc register number to DWARF 2 CFA column number. By
432 default, we just provide columns for all registers. */
433 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM
434 #define DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM(REG) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (REG)
435 #endif
436 \f
437 /* Hook used by __throw. */
438
439 rtx
440 expand_builtin_dwarf_sp_column (void)
441 {
442 unsigned int dwarf_regnum = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
443 return GEN_INT (DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (dwarf_regnum, 1));
444 }
445
446 /* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
447 attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name). */
448
449 static inline char *
450 stripattributes (const char *s)
451 {
452 char *stripped = XNEWVEC (char, strlen (s) + 2);
453 char *p = stripped;
454
455 *p++ = '*';
456
457 while (*s && *s != ',')
458 *p++ = *s++;
459
460 *p = '\0';
461 return stripped;
462 }
463
464 /* MEM is a memory reference for the register size table, each element of
465 which has mode MODE. Initialize column C as a return address column. */
466
467 static void
468 init_return_column_size (enum machine_mode mode, rtx mem, unsigned int c)
469 {
470 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = c * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
471 HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_SIZE (Pmode);
472 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset), GEN_INT (size));
473 }
474
475 /* Generate code to initialize the register size table. */
476
477 void
478 expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes (tree address)
479 {
480 unsigned int i;
481 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (char_type_node);
482 rtx addr = expand_normal (address);
483 rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, addr);
484 bool wrote_return_column = false;
485
486 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
487 {
488 int rnum = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i), 1);
489
490 if (rnum < DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS)
491 {
492 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = rnum * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
493 enum machine_mode save_mode = reg_raw_mode[i];
494 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
495
496 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (i, save_mode))
497 save_mode = choose_hard_reg_mode (i, 1, true);
498 if (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
499 {
500 if (save_mode == VOIDmode)
501 continue;
502 wrote_return_column = true;
503 }
504 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
505 if (offset < 0)
506 continue;
507
508 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset),
509 gen_int_mode (size, mode));
510 }
511 }
512
513 if (!wrote_return_column)
514 init_return_column_size (mode, mem, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN);
515
516 #ifdef DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
517 init_return_column_size (mode, mem, DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN);
518 #endif
519
520 targetm.init_dwarf_reg_sizes_extra (address);
521 }
522
523 /* Convert a DWARF call frame info. operation to its string name */
524
525 static const char *
526 dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned int cfi_opc)
527 {
528 switch (cfi_opc)
529 {
530 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
531 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc";
532 case DW_CFA_offset:
533 return "DW_CFA_offset";
534 case DW_CFA_restore:
535 return "DW_CFA_restore";
536 case DW_CFA_nop:
537 return "DW_CFA_nop";
538 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
539 return "DW_CFA_set_loc";
540 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
541 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc1";
542 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
543 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc2";
544 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
545 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc4";
546 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
547 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended";
548 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
549 return "DW_CFA_restore_extended";
550 case DW_CFA_undefined:
551 return "DW_CFA_undefined";
552 case DW_CFA_same_value:
553 return "DW_CFA_same_value";
554 case DW_CFA_register:
555 return "DW_CFA_register";
556 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
557 return "DW_CFA_remember_state";
558 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
559 return "DW_CFA_restore_state";
560 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
561 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa";
562 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
563 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register";
564 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
565 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset";
566
567 /* DWARF 3 */
568 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
569 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression";
570 case DW_CFA_expression:
571 return "DW_CFA_expression";
572 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
573 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf";
574 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
575 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf";
576 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
577 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf";
578
579 /* SGI/MIPS specific */
580 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
581 return "DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8";
582
583 /* GNU extensions */
584 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
585 return "DW_CFA_GNU_window_save";
586 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
587 return "DW_CFA_GNU_args_size";
588 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
589 return "DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended";
590
591 default:
592 return "DW_CFA_<unknown>";
593 }
594 }
595
596 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated Call Frame Instruction. */
597
598 static inline dw_cfi_ref
599 new_cfi (void)
600 {
601 dw_cfi_ref cfi = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_cfi_node));
602
603 cfi->dw_cfi_next = NULL;
604 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
605 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
606
607 return cfi;
608 }
609
610 /* Add a Call Frame Instruction to list of instructions. */
611
612 static inline void
613 add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *list_head, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
614 {
615 dw_cfi_ref *p;
616
617 /* Find the end of the chain. */
618 for (p = list_head; (*p) != NULL; p = &(*p)->dw_cfi_next)
619 ;
620
621 *p = cfi;
622 }
623
624 /* Generate a new label for the CFI info to refer to. */
625
626 char *
627 dwarf2out_cfi_label (void)
628 {
629 static char label[20];
630
631 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LCFI", dwarf2out_cfi_label_num++);
632 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
633 return label;
634 }
635
636 /* Add CFI to the current fde at the PC value indicated by LABEL if specified,
637 or to the CIE if LABEL is NULL. */
638
639 static void
640 add_fde_cfi (const char *label, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
641 {
642 if (label)
643 {
644 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
645
646 if (*label == 0)
647 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
648
649 if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
650 || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
651 {
652 dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
653
654 label = xstrdup (label);
655
656 /* Set the location counter to the new label. */
657 xcfi = new_cfi ();
658 /* If we have a current label, advance from there, otherwise
659 set the location directly using set_loc. */
660 xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = fde->dw_fde_current_label
661 ? DW_CFA_advance_loc4
662 : DW_CFA_set_loc;
663 xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
664 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
665
666 fde->dw_fde_current_label = label;
667 }
668
669 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, cfi);
670 }
671
672 else
673 add_cfi (&cie_cfi_head, cfi);
674 }
675
676 /* Subroutine of lookup_cfa. */
677
678 static void
679 lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_cfa_location *loc)
680 {
681 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
682 {
683 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
684 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset;
685 break;
686 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
687 loc->offset
688 = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
689 break;
690 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
691 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
692 break;
693 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
694 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
695 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset;
696 break;
697 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
698 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
699 loc->offset
700 = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
701 break;
702 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
703 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (loc, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc);
704 break;
705 default:
706 break;
707 }
708 }
709
710 /* Find the previous value for the CFA. */
711
712 static void
713 lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *loc)
714 {
715 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
716
717 loc->reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
718 loc->offset = 0;
719 loc->indirect = 0;
720 loc->base_offset = 0;
721
722 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
723 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
724
725 if (fde_table_in_use)
726 {
727 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
728 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
729 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
730 }
731 }
732
733 /* The current rule for calculating the DWARF2 canonical frame address. */
734 static dw_cfa_location cfa;
735
736 /* The register used for saving registers to the stack, and its offset
737 from the CFA. */
738 static dw_cfa_location cfa_store;
739
740 /* The running total of the size of arguments pushed onto the stack. */
741 static HOST_WIDE_INT args_size;
742
743 /* The last args_size we actually output. */
744 static HOST_WIDE_INT old_args_size;
745
746 /* Entry point to update the canonical frame address (CFA).
747 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi. The value of CFA is now to be
748 calculated from REG+OFFSET. */
749
750 void
751 dwarf2out_def_cfa (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
752 {
753 dw_cfa_location loc;
754 loc.indirect = 0;
755 loc.base_offset = 0;
756 loc.reg = reg;
757 loc.offset = offset;
758 def_cfa_1 (label, &loc);
759 }
760
761 /* Determine if two dw_cfa_location structures define the same data. */
762
763 static bool
764 cfa_equal_p (const dw_cfa_location *loc1, const dw_cfa_location *loc2)
765 {
766 return (loc1->reg == loc2->reg
767 && loc1->offset == loc2->offset
768 && loc1->indirect == loc2->indirect
769 && (loc1->indirect == 0
770 || loc1->base_offset == loc2->base_offset));
771 }
772
773 /* This routine does the actual work. The CFA is now calculated from
774 the dw_cfa_location structure. */
775
776 static void
777 def_cfa_1 (const char *label, dw_cfa_location *loc_p)
778 {
779 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
780 dw_cfa_location old_cfa, loc;
781
782 cfa = *loc_p;
783 loc = *loc_p;
784
785 if (cfa_store.reg == loc.reg && loc.indirect == 0)
786 cfa_store.offset = loc.offset;
787
788 loc.reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (loc.reg);
789 lookup_cfa (&old_cfa);
790
791 /* If nothing changed, no need to issue any call frame instructions. */
792 if (cfa_equal_p (&loc, &old_cfa))
793 return;
794
795 cfi = new_cfi ();
796
797 if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && !loc.indirect)
798 {
799 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset <offset>" instruction, indicating
800 the CFA register did not change but the offset did. */
801 if (loc.offset < 0)
802 {
803 HOST_WIDE_INT f_offset = loc.offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
804 gcc_assert (f_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == loc.offset);
805
806 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf;
807 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = f_offset;
808 }
809 else
810 {
811 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
812 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
813 }
814 }
815
816 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO /* SGI dbx thinks this means no offset. */
817 else if (loc.offset == old_cfa.offset
818 && old_cfa.reg != INVALID_REGNUM
819 && !loc.indirect)
820 {
821 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register <register>" instruction,
822 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> but the
823 offset has not changed. */
824 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_register;
825 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
826 }
827 #endif
828
829 else if (loc.indirect == 0)
830 {
831 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa <register> <offset>" instruction,
832 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> with
833 the specified offset. */
834 if (loc.offset < 0)
835 {
836 HOST_WIDE_INT f_offset = loc.offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
837 gcc_assert (f_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == loc.offset);
838
839 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf;
840 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
841 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = f_offset;
842 }
843 else
844 {
845 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
846 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
847 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
848 }
849 }
850 else
851 {
852 /* Construct a DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instruction to
853 calculate the CFA using a full location expression since no
854 register-offset pair is available. */
855 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc_list;
856
857 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression;
858 loc_list = build_cfa_loc (&loc, 0);
859 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc = loc_list;
860 }
861
862 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
863 }
864
865 /* Add the CFI for saving a register. REG is the CFA column number.
866 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.
867 If SREG is -1, the register is saved at OFFSET from the CFA;
868 otherwise it is saved in SREG. */
869
870 static void
871 reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, unsigned int sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
872 {
873 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
874
875 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
876
877 if (sreg == INVALID_REGNUM)
878 {
879 if (reg & ~0x3f)
880 /* The register number won't fit in 6 bits, so we have to use
881 the long form. */
882 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended;
883 else
884 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset;
885
886 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
887 {
888 /* If we get an offset that is not a multiple of
889 DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, there is either a bug in the
890 definition of DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, or a bug in the machine
891 description. */
892 HOST_WIDE_INT check_offset = offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
893
894 gcc_assert (check_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == offset);
895 }
896 #endif
897 offset /= DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
898 if (offset < 0)
899 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
900
901 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = offset;
902 }
903 else if (sreg == reg)
904 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_same_value;
905 else
906 {
907 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_register;
908 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = sreg;
909 }
910
911 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
912 }
913
914 /* Add the CFI for saving a register window. LABEL is passed to reg_save.
915 This CFI tells the unwinder that it needs to restore the window registers
916 from the previous frame's window save area.
917
918 ??? Perhaps we should note in the CIE where windows are saved (instead of
919 assuming 0(cfa)) and what registers are in the window. */
920
921 void
922 dwarf2out_window_save (const char *label)
923 {
924 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
925
926 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_window_save;
927 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
928 }
929
930 /* Add a CFI to update the running total of the size of arguments
931 pushed onto the stack. */
932
933 void
934 dwarf2out_args_size (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
935 {
936 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
937
938 if (size == old_args_size)
939 return;
940
941 old_args_size = size;
942
943 cfi = new_cfi ();
944 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_args_size;
945 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = size;
946 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
947 }
948
949 /* Entry point for saving a register to the stack. REG is the GCC register
950 number. LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
951
952 void
953 dwarf2out_reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
954 {
955 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (reg), INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
956 }
957
958 /* Entry point for saving the return address in the stack.
959 LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
960
961 void
962 dwarf2out_return_save (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
963 {
964 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
965 }
966
967 /* Entry point for saving the return address in a register.
968 LABEL and SREG are passed to reg_save. */
969
970 void
971 dwarf2out_return_reg (const char *label, unsigned int sreg)
972 {
973 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (sreg), 0);
974 }
975
976 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
977 /* Record the initial position of the return address. RTL is
978 INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX. */
979
980 static void
981 initial_return_save (rtx rtl)
982 {
983 unsigned int reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
984 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
985
986 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
987 {
988 case REG:
989 /* RA is in a register. */
990 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (rtl));
991 break;
992
993 case MEM:
994 /* RA is on the stack. */
995 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
996 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
997 {
998 case REG:
999 gcc_assert (REGNO (rtl) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1000 offset = 0;
1001 break;
1002
1003 case PLUS:
1004 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1005 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
1006 break;
1007
1008 case MINUS:
1009 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1010 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
1011 break;
1012
1013 default:
1014 gcc_unreachable ();
1015 }
1016
1017 break;
1018
1019 case PLUS:
1020 /* The return address is at some offset from any value we can
1021 actually load. For instance, on the SPARC it is in %i7+8. Just
1022 ignore the offset for now; it doesn't matter for unwinding frames. */
1023 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1024 initial_return_save (XEXP (rtl, 0));
1025 return;
1026
1027 default:
1028 gcc_unreachable ();
1029 }
1030
1031 if (reg != DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
1032 reg_save (NULL, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, reg, offset - cfa.offset);
1033 }
1034 #endif
1035
1036 /* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it
1037 contains. */
1038
1039 static HOST_WIDE_INT
1040 stack_adjust_offset (const_rtx pattern)
1041 {
1042 const_rtx src = SET_SRC (pattern);
1043 const_rtx dest = SET_DEST (pattern);
1044 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1045 enum rtx_code code;
1046
1047 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1048 {
1049 /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
1050 code = GET_CODE (src);
1051 if (! (code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
1052 || XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
1053 || GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) != CONST_INT)
1054 return 0;
1055
1056 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1057 if (code == PLUS)
1058 offset = -offset;
1059 }
1060 else if (MEM_P (dest))
1061 {
1062 /* (set (mem (pre_dec (reg sp))) (foo)) */
1063 src = XEXP (dest, 0);
1064 code = GET_CODE (src);
1065
1066 switch (code)
1067 {
1068 case PRE_MODIFY:
1069 case POST_MODIFY:
1070 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1071 {
1072 rtx val = XEXP (XEXP (src, 1), 1);
1073 /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount. */
1074 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == PLUS
1075 && GET_CODE (val) == CONST_INT);
1076 offset = -INTVAL (val);
1077 break;
1078 }
1079 return 0;
1080
1081 case PRE_DEC:
1082 case POST_DEC:
1083 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1084 {
1085 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1086 break;
1087 }
1088 return 0;
1089
1090 case PRE_INC:
1091 case POST_INC:
1092 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1093 {
1094 offset = -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1095 break;
1096 }
1097 return 0;
1098
1099 default:
1100 return 0;
1101 }
1102 }
1103 else
1104 return 0;
1105
1106 return offset;
1107 }
1108
1109 /* Check INSN to see if it looks like a push or a stack adjustment, and
1110 make a note of it if it does. EH uses this information to find out how
1111 much extra space it needs to pop off the stack. */
1112
1113 static void
1114 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1115 {
1116 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1117 const char *label;
1118 int i;
1119
1120 /* Don't handle epilogues at all. Certainly it would be wrong to do so
1121 with this function. Proper support would require all frame-related
1122 insns to be marked, and to be able to handle saving state around
1123 epilogues textually in the middle of the function. */
1124 if (prologue_epilogue_contains (insn) || sibcall_epilogue_contains (insn))
1125 return;
1126
1127 /* If only calls can throw, and we have a frame pointer,
1128 save up adjustments until we see the CALL_INSN. */
1129 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1130 {
1131 if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1132 {
1133 /* Extract the size of the args from the CALL rtx itself. */
1134 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1135 if (GET_CODE (insn) == PARALLEL)
1136 insn = XVECEXP (insn, 0, 0);
1137 if (GET_CODE (insn) == SET)
1138 insn = SET_SRC (insn);
1139 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL);
1140 dwarf2out_args_size ("", INTVAL (XEXP (insn, 1)));
1141 }
1142 return;
1143 }
1144
1145 if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1146 {
1147 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1148 dwarf2out_args_size ("", args_size);
1149 return;
1150 }
1151 else if (BARRIER_P (insn))
1152 {
1153 /* When we see a BARRIER, we know to reset args_size to 0. Usually
1154 the compiler will have already emitted a stack adjustment, but
1155 doesn't bother for calls to noreturn functions. */
1156 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1157 offset = -args_size;
1158 #else
1159 offset = args_size;
1160 #endif
1161 }
1162 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1163 offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn));
1164 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1165 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1166 {
1167 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
1168 for them. */
1169 for (offset = 0, i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1170 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1171 offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i));
1172 }
1173 else
1174 return;
1175
1176 if (offset == 0)
1177 return;
1178
1179 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1180 cfa.offset += offset;
1181
1182 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1183 offset = -offset;
1184 #endif
1185
1186 args_size += offset;
1187 if (args_size < 0)
1188 args_size = 0;
1189
1190 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1191 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1192 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1193 dwarf2out_args_size (label, args_size);
1194 }
1195
1196 #endif
1197
1198 /* We delay emitting a register save until either (a) we reach the end
1199 of the prologue or (b) the register is clobbered. This clusters
1200 register saves so that there are fewer pc advances. */
1201
1202 struct queued_reg_save GTY(())
1203 {
1204 struct queued_reg_save *next;
1205 rtx reg;
1206 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_offset;
1207 rtx saved_reg;
1208 };
1209
1210 static GTY(()) struct queued_reg_save *queued_reg_saves;
1211
1212 /* The caller's ORIG_REG is saved in SAVED_IN_REG. */
1213 struct reg_saved_in_data GTY(()) {
1214 rtx orig_reg;
1215 rtx saved_in_reg;
1216 };
1217
1218 /* A list of registers saved in other registers.
1219 The list intentionally has a small maximum capacity of 4; if your
1220 port needs more than that, you might consider implementing a
1221 more efficient data structure. */
1222 static GTY(()) struct reg_saved_in_data regs_saved_in_regs[4];
1223 static GTY(()) size_t num_regs_saved_in_regs;
1224
1225 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1226 static const char *last_reg_save_label;
1227
1228 /* Add an entry to QUEUED_REG_SAVES saying that REG is now saved at
1229 SREG, or if SREG is NULL then it is saved at OFFSET to the CFA. */
1230
1231 static void
1232 queue_reg_save (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1233 {
1234 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1235
1236 /* Duplicates waste space, but it's also necessary to remove them
1237 for correctness, since the queue gets output in reverse
1238 order. */
1239 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q != NULL; q = q->next)
1240 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (reg))
1241 break;
1242
1243 if (q == NULL)
1244 {
1245 q = ggc_alloc (sizeof (*q));
1246 q->next = queued_reg_saves;
1247 queued_reg_saves = q;
1248 }
1249
1250 q->reg = reg;
1251 q->cfa_offset = offset;
1252 q->saved_reg = sreg;
1253
1254 last_reg_save_label = label;
1255 }
1256
1257 /* Output all the entries in QUEUED_REG_SAVES. */
1258
1259 static void
1260 flush_queued_reg_saves (void)
1261 {
1262 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1263
1264 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1265 {
1266 size_t i;
1267 unsigned int reg, sreg;
1268
1269 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1270 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (q->reg))
1271 break;
1272 if (q->saved_reg && i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1273 {
1274 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1275 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1276 }
1277 if (i != num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1278 {
1279 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = q->reg;
1280 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = q->saved_reg;
1281 }
1282
1283 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->reg));
1284 if (q->saved_reg)
1285 sreg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->saved_reg));
1286 else
1287 sreg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1288 reg_save (last_reg_save_label, reg, sreg, q->cfa_offset);
1289 }
1290
1291 queued_reg_saves = NULL;
1292 last_reg_save_label = NULL;
1293 }
1294
1295 /* Does INSN clobber any register which QUEUED_REG_SAVES lists a saved
1296 location for? Or, does it clobber a register which we've previously
1297 said that some other register is saved in, and for which we now
1298 have a new location for? */
1299
1300 static bool
1301 clobbers_queued_reg_save (const_rtx insn)
1302 {
1303 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1304
1305 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1306 {
1307 size_t i;
1308 if (modified_in_p (q->reg, insn))
1309 return true;
1310 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1311 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg)
1312 && modified_in_p (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg, insn))
1313 return true;
1314 }
1315
1316 return false;
1317 }
1318
1319 /* Entry point for saving the first register into the second. */
1320
1321 void
1322 dwarf2out_reg_save_reg (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg)
1323 {
1324 size_t i;
1325 unsigned int regno, sregno;
1326
1327 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1328 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (reg))
1329 break;
1330 if (i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1331 {
1332 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1333 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1334 }
1335 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = reg;
1336 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = sreg;
1337
1338 regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (reg));
1339 sregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (sreg));
1340 reg_save (label, regno, sregno, 0);
1341 }
1342
1343 /* What register, if any, is currently saved in REG? */
1344
1345 static rtx
1346 reg_saved_in (rtx reg)
1347 {
1348 unsigned int regn = REGNO (reg);
1349 size_t i;
1350 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1351
1352 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1353 if (q->saved_reg && regn == REGNO (q->saved_reg))
1354 return q->reg;
1355
1356 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1357 if (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg
1358 && regn == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg))
1359 return regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg;
1360
1361 return NULL_RTX;
1362 }
1363
1364
1365 /* A temporary register holding an integral value used in adjusting SP
1366 or setting up the store_reg. The "offset" field holds the integer
1367 value, not an offset. */
1368 static dw_cfa_location cfa_temp;
1369
1370 /* Record call frame debugging information for an expression EXPR,
1371 which either sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame
1372 address) or saves a register to the stack or another register.
1373 LABEL indicates the address of EXPR.
1374
1375 This function encodes a state machine mapping rtxes to actions on
1376 cfa, cfa_store, and cfa_temp.reg. We describe these rules so
1377 users need not read the source code.
1378
1379 The High-Level Picture
1380
1381 Changes in the register we use to calculate the CFA: Currently we
1382 assume that if you copy the CFA register into another register, we
1383 should take the other one as the new CFA register; this seems to
1384 work pretty well. If it's wrong for some target, it's simple
1385 enough not to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on the insn in question.
1386
1387 Changes in the register we use for saving registers to the stack:
1388 This is usually SP, but not always. Again, we deduce that if you
1389 copy SP into another register (and SP is not the CFA register),
1390 then the new register is the one we will be using for register
1391 saves. This also seems to work.
1392
1393 Register saves: There's not much guesswork about this one; if
1394 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on an insn which modifies memory, it's a
1395 register save, and the register used to calculate the destination
1396 had better be the one we think we're using for this purpose.
1397 It's also assumed that a copy from a call-saved register to another
1398 register is saving that register if RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on
1399 that instruction. If the copy is from a call-saved register to
1400 the *same* register, that means that the register is now the same
1401 value as in the caller.
1402
1403 Except: If the register being saved is the CFA register, and the
1404 offset is nonzero, we are saving the CFA, so we assume we have to
1405 use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression. If the offset is 0, we assume that
1406 the intent is to save the value of SP from the previous frame.
1407
1408 In addition, if a register has previously been saved to a different
1409 register,
1410
1411 Invariants / Summaries of Rules
1412
1413 cfa current rule for calculating the CFA. It usually
1414 consists of a register and an offset.
1415 cfa_store register used by prologue code to save things to the stack
1416 cfa_store.offset is the offset from the value of
1417 cfa_store.reg to the actual CFA
1418 cfa_temp register holding an integral value. cfa_temp.offset
1419 stores the value, which will be used to adjust the
1420 stack pointer. cfa_temp is also used like cfa_store,
1421 to track stores to the stack via fp or a temp reg.
1422
1423 Rules 1- 4: Setting a register's value to cfa.reg or an expression
1424 with cfa.reg as the first operand changes the cfa.reg and its
1425 cfa.offset. Rule 1 and 4 also set cfa_temp.reg and
1426 cfa_temp.offset.
1427
1428 Rules 6- 9: Set a non-cfa.reg register value to a constant or an
1429 expression yielding a constant. This sets cfa_temp.reg
1430 and cfa_temp.offset.
1431
1432 Rule 5: Create a new register cfa_store used to save items to the
1433 stack.
1434
1435 Rules 10-14: Save a register to the stack. Define offset as the
1436 difference of the original location and cfa_store's
1437 location (or cfa_temp's location if cfa_temp is used).
1438
1439 The Rules
1440
1441 "{a,b}" indicates a choice of a xor b.
1442 "<reg>:cfa.reg" indicates that <reg> must equal cfa.reg.
1443
1444 Rule 1:
1445 (set <reg1> <reg2>:cfa.reg)
1446 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1447 cfa.offset unchanged
1448 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1449 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1450
1451 Rule 2:
1452 (set sp ({minus,plus,losum} {sp,fp}:cfa.reg
1453 {<const_int>,<reg>:cfa_temp.reg}))
1454 effects: cfa.reg = sp if fp used
1455 cfa.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset} if cfa.reg==sp
1456 cfa_store.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset}
1457 if cfa_store.reg==sp
1458
1459 Rule 3:
1460 (set fp ({minus,plus,losum} <reg>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1461 effects: cfa.reg = fp
1462 cfa_offset += +/- <const_int>
1463
1464 Rule 4:
1465 (set <reg1> ({plus,losum} <reg2>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1466 constraints: <reg1> != fp
1467 <reg1> != sp
1468 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1469 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1470 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1471
1472 Rule 5:
1473 (set <reg1> (plus <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg sp:cfa.reg))
1474 constraints: <reg1> != fp
1475 <reg1> != sp
1476 effects: cfa_store.reg = <reg1>
1477 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset
1478
1479 Rule 6:
1480 (set <reg> <const_int>)
1481 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1482 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1483
1484 Rule 7:
1485 (set <reg1>:cfa_temp.reg (ior <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg <const_int>))
1486 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1487 cfa_temp.offset |= <const_int>
1488
1489 Rule 8:
1490 (set <reg> (high <exp>))
1491 effects: none
1492
1493 Rule 9:
1494 (set <reg> (lo_sum <exp> <const_int>))
1495 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1496 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1497
1498 Rule 10:
1499 (set (mem (pre_modify sp:cfa_store (???? <reg1> <const_int>))) <reg2>)
1500 effects: cfa_store.offset -= <const_int>
1501 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1502 cfa.reg = sp
1503 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1504
1505 Rule 11:
1506 (set (mem ({pre_inc,pre_dec} sp:cfa_store.reg)) <reg>)
1507 effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
1508 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1509 cfa.reg = sp
1510 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1511
1512 Rule 12:
1513 (set (mem ({minus,plus,losum} <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp} <const_int>))
1514
1515 <reg2>)
1516 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1517 cfa.base_offset = -/+ <const_int> - {cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1518
1519 Rule 13:
1520 (set (mem <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp}) <reg2>)
1521 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1522 cfa.base_offset = -{cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1523
1524 Rule 14:
1525 (set (mem (postinc <reg1>:cfa_temp <const_int>)) <reg2>)
1526 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1527 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_temp.offset
1528 cfa_temp.offset -= mode_size(mem)
1529
1530 Rule 15:
1531 (set <reg> {unspec, unspec_volatile})
1532 effects: target-dependent */
1533
1534 static void
1535 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx expr, const char *label)
1536 {
1537 rtx src, dest, span;
1538 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1539
1540 /* If RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on a PARALLEL, process each member of
1541 the PARALLEL independently. The first element is always processed if
1542 it is a SET. This is for backward compatibility. Other elements
1543 are processed only if they are SETs and the RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P
1544 flag is set in them. */
1545 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
1546 {
1547 int par_index;
1548 int limit = XVECLEN (expr, 0);
1549 rtx elem;
1550
1551 /* PARALLELs have strict read-modify-write semantics, so we
1552 ought to evaluate every rvalue before changing any lvalue.
1553 It's cumbersome to do that in general, but there's an
1554 easy approximation that is enough for all current users:
1555 handle register saves before register assignments. */
1556 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL)
1557 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
1558 {
1559 elem = XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index);
1560 if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET
1561 && MEM_P (SET_DEST (elem))
1562 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem) || par_index == 0))
1563 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (elem, label);
1564 }
1565
1566 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
1567 {
1568 elem = XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index);
1569 if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET
1570 && (!MEM_P (SET_DEST (elem)) || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
1571 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem) || par_index == 0))
1572 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (elem, label);
1573 }
1574 return;
1575 }
1576
1577 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == SET);
1578
1579 src = SET_SRC (expr);
1580 dest = SET_DEST (expr);
1581
1582 if (REG_P (src))
1583 {
1584 rtx rsi = reg_saved_in (src);
1585 if (rsi)
1586 src = rsi;
1587 }
1588
1589 switch (GET_CODE (dest))
1590 {
1591 case REG:
1592 switch (GET_CODE (src))
1593 {
1594 /* Setting FP from SP. */
1595 case REG:
1596 if (cfa.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (src))
1597 {
1598 /* Rule 1 */
1599 /* Update the CFA rule wrt SP or FP. Make sure src is
1600 relative to the current CFA register.
1601
1602 We used to require that dest be either SP or FP, but the
1603 ARM copies SP to a temporary register, and from there to
1604 FP. So we just rely on the backends to only set
1605 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on appropriate insns. */
1606 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1607 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1608 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1609 }
1610 else
1611 {
1612 /* Saving a register in a register. */
1613 gcc_assert (!fixed_regs [REGNO (dest)]
1614 /* For the SPARC and its register window. */
1615 || (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src))
1616 == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN));
1617 queue_reg_save (label, src, dest, 0);
1618 }
1619 break;
1620
1621 case PLUS:
1622 case MINUS:
1623 case LO_SUM:
1624 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1625 {
1626 /* Rule 2 */
1627 /* Adjusting SP. */
1628 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)))
1629 {
1630 case CONST_INT:
1631 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1632 break;
1633 case REG:
1634 gcc_assert ((unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 1))
1635 == cfa_temp.reg);
1636 offset = cfa_temp.offset;
1637 break;
1638 default:
1639 gcc_unreachable ();
1640 }
1641
1642 if (XEXP (src, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1643 {
1644 /* Restoring SP from FP in the epilogue. */
1645 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == (unsigned) HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
1646 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1647 }
1648 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM)
1649 /* Assume we've set the source reg of the LO_SUM from sp. */
1650 ;
1651 else
1652 gcc_assert (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx);
1653
1654 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1655 offset = -offset;
1656 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1657 cfa.offset += offset;
1658 if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1659 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1660 }
1661 else if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1662 {
1663 /* Rule 3 */
1664 /* Either setting the FP from an offset of the SP,
1665 or adjusting the FP */
1666 gcc_assert (frame_pointer_needed);
1667
1668 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1669 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1670 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1671 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1672 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1673 offset = -offset;
1674 cfa.offset += offset;
1675 cfa.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
1676 }
1677 else
1678 {
1679 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS);
1680
1681 /* Rule 4 */
1682 if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1683 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1684 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1685 {
1686 /* Setting a temporary CFA register that will be copied
1687 into the FP later on. */
1688 offset = - INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1689 cfa.offset += offset;
1690 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1691 /* Or used to save regs to the stack. */
1692 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1693 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1694 }
1695
1696 /* Rule 5 */
1697 else if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1698 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1699 && XEXP (src, 1) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1700 {
1701 /* Setting a scratch register that we will use instead
1702 of SP for saving registers to the stack. */
1703 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1704 cfa_store.reg = REGNO (dest);
1705 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset;
1706 }
1707
1708 /* Rule 9 */
1709 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM
1710 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1711 {
1712 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1713 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1714 }
1715 else
1716 gcc_unreachable ();
1717 }
1718 break;
1719
1720 /* Rule 6 */
1721 case CONST_INT:
1722 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1723 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (src);
1724 break;
1725
1726 /* Rule 7 */
1727 case IOR:
1728 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1729 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1730 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1731
1732 if ((unsigned) REGNO (dest) != cfa_temp.reg)
1733 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1734 cfa_temp.offset |= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1735 break;
1736
1737 /* Skip over HIGH, assuming it will be followed by a LO_SUM,
1738 which will fill in all of the bits. */
1739 /* Rule 8 */
1740 case HIGH:
1741 break;
1742
1743 /* Rule 15 */
1744 case UNSPEC:
1745 case UNSPEC_VOLATILE:
1746 gcc_assert (targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec);
1747 targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec (label, expr, XINT (src, 1));
1748 return;
1749
1750 default:
1751 gcc_unreachable ();
1752 }
1753
1754 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1755 break;
1756
1757 case MEM:
1758 gcc_assert (REG_P (src));
1759
1760 /* Saving a register to the stack. Make sure dest is relative to the
1761 CFA register. */
1762 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)))
1763 {
1764 /* Rule 10 */
1765 /* With a push. */
1766 case PRE_MODIFY:
1767 /* We can't handle variable size modifications. */
1768 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1))
1769 == CONST_INT);
1770 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1));
1771
1772 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1773 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1774
1775 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1776 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1777 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1778
1779 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1780 break;
1781
1782 /* Rule 11 */
1783 case PRE_INC:
1784 case PRE_DEC:
1785 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1786 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == PRE_INC)
1787 offset = -offset;
1788
1789 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1790 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1791
1792 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1793 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1794 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1795
1796 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1797 break;
1798
1799 /* Rule 12 */
1800 /* With an offset. */
1801 case PLUS:
1802 case MINUS:
1803 case LO_SUM:
1804 {
1805 int regno;
1806
1807 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
1808 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
1809 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1));
1810 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == MINUS)
1811 offset = -offset;
1812
1813 regno = REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0));
1814
1815 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
1816 offset -= cfa_store.offset;
1817 else
1818 {
1819 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
1820 offset -= cfa_temp.offset;
1821 }
1822 }
1823 break;
1824
1825 /* Rule 13 */
1826 /* Without an offset. */
1827 case REG:
1828 {
1829 int regno = REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0));
1830
1831 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
1832 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1833 else
1834 {
1835 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
1836 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1837 }
1838 }
1839 break;
1840
1841 /* Rule 14 */
1842 case POST_INC:
1843 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg
1844 == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
1845 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1846 cfa_temp.offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1847 break;
1848
1849 default:
1850 gcc_unreachable ();
1851 }
1852
1853 if (REGNO (src) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1854 && REGNO (src) != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1855 && (unsigned) REGNO (src) == cfa.reg)
1856 {
1857 /* We're storing the current CFA reg into the stack. */
1858
1859 if (cfa.offset == 0)
1860 {
1861 /* If the source register is exactly the CFA, assume
1862 we're saving SP like any other register; this happens
1863 on the ARM. */
1864 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1865 queue_reg_save (label, stack_pointer_rtx, NULL_RTX, offset);
1866 break;
1867 }
1868 else
1869 {
1870 /* Otherwise, we'll need to look in the stack to
1871 calculate the CFA. */
1872 rtx x = XEXP (dest, 0);
1873
1874 if (!REG_P (x))
1875 x = XEXP (x, 0);
1876 gcc_assert (REG_P (x));
1877
1878 cfa.reg = REGNO (x);
1879 cfa.base_offset = offset;
1880 cfa.indirect = 1;
1881 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1882 break;
1883 }
1884 }
1885
1886 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1887 {
1888 span = targetm.dwarf_register_span (src);
1889
1890 if (!span)
1891 queue_reg_save (label, src, NULL_RTX, offset);
1892 else
1893 {
1894 /* We have a PARALLEL describing where the contents of SRC
1895 live. Queue register saves for each piece of the
1896 PARALLEL. */
1897 int par_index;
1898 int limit;
1899 HOST_WIDE_INT span_offset = offset;
1900
1901 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (span) == PARALLEL);
1902
1903 limit = XVECLEN (span, 0);
1904 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
1905 {
1906 rtx elem = XVECEXP (span, 0, par_index);
1907
1908 queue_reg_save (label, elem, NULL_RTX, span_offset);
1909 span_offset += GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (elem));
1910 }
1911 }
1912 }
1913 break;
1914
1915 default:
1916 gcc_unreachable ();
1917 }
1918 }
1919
1920 /* Record call frame debugging information for INSN, which either
1921 sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame address) or saves a
1922 register to the stack. If INSN is NULL_RTX, initialize our state.
1923
1924 If AFTER_P is false, we're being called before the insn is emitted,
1925 otherwise after. Call instructions get invoked twice. */
1926
1927 void
1928 dwarf2out_frame_debug (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1929 {
1930 const char *label;
1931 rtx src;
1932
1933 if (insn == NULL_RTX)
1934 {
1935 size_t i;
1936
1937 /* Flush any queued register saves. */
1938 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1939
1940 /* Set up state for generating call frame debug info. */
1941 lookup_cfa (&cfa);
1942 gcc_assert (cfa.reg
1943 == (unsigned long)DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM));
1944
1945 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1946 cfa_store = cfa;
1947 cfa_temp.reg = -1;
1948 cfa_temp.offset = 0;
1949
1950 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1951 {
1952 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = NULL_RTX;
1953 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = NULL_RTX;
1954 }
1955 num_regs_saved_in_regs = 0;
1956 return;
1957 }
1958
1959 if (!NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn) || clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn))
1960 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1961
1962 if (! RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
1963 {
1964 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
1965 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (insn, after_p);
1966 return;
1967 }
1968
1969 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1970 src = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
1971 if (src)
1972 insn = XEXP (src, 0);
1973 else
1974 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1975
1976 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (insn, label);
1977 }
1978
1979 #endif
1980
1981 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used. */
1982 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc
1983 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
1984
1985 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
1986 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
1987 {
1988 switch (cfi)
1989 {
1990 case DW_CFA_nop:
1991 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
1992 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
1993
1994 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
1995 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
1996 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
1997 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
1998 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
1999 return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
2000
2001 case DW_CFA_offset:
2002 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
2003 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
2004 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
2005 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
2006 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
2007 case DW_CFA_undefined:
2008 case DW_CFA_same_value:
2009 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
2010 case DW_CFA_register:
2011 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
2012
2013 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
2014 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
2015 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
2016 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
2017
2018 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
2019 case DW_CFA_expression:
2020 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
2021
2022 default:
2023 gcc_unreachable ();
2024 }
2025 }
2026
2027 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used. */
2028 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc
2029 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
2030
2031 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
2032 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
2033 {
2034 switch (cfi)
2035 {
2036 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
2037 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
2038 case DW_CFA_offset:
2039 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
2040 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
2041 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
2042
2043 case DW_CFA_register:
2044 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
2045
2046 default:
2047 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
2048 }
2049 }
2050
2051 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2052
2053 /* Switch to eh_frame_section. If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
2054 switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic label
2055 for collect2. */
2056
2057 static void
2058 switch_to_eh_frame_section (void)
2059 {
2060 tree label;
2061
2062 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
2063 if (eh_frame_section == 0)
2064 {
2065 int flags;
2066
2067 if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
2068 {
2069 int fde_encoding;
2070 int per_encoding;
2071 int lsda_encoding;
2072
2073 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
2074 /*global=*/0);
2075 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
2076 /*global=*/1);
2077 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
2078 /*global=*/0);
2079 flags = ((! flag_pic
2080 || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2081 && (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
2082 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2083 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
2084 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2085 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
2086 ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
2087 }
2088 else
2089 flags = SECTION_WRITE;
2090 eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
2091 }
2092 #endif
2093
2094 if (eh_frame_section)
2095 switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
2096 else
2097 {
2098 /* We have no special eh_frame section. Put the information in
2099 the data section and emit special labels to guide collect2. */
2100 switch_to_section (data_section);
2101 label = get_file_function_name ("F");
2102 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
2103 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
2104 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
2105 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
2106 }
2107 }
2108
2109 /* Output a Call Frame Information opcode and its operand(s). */
2110
2111 static void
2112 output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_fde_ref fde, int for_eh)
2113 {
2114 unsigned long r;
2115 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_advance_loc)
2116 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
2117 | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset & 0x3f)),
2118 "DW_CFA_advance_loc " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
2119 ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)
2120 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset));
2121 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_offset)
2122 {
2123 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2124 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
2125 "DW_CFA_offset, column 0x%lx", r);
2126 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2127 }
2128 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore)
2129 {
2130 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2131 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
2132 "DW_CFA_restore, column 0x%lx", r);
2133 }
2134 else
2135 {
2136 dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_opc,
2137 "%s", dwarf_cfi_name (cfi->dw_cfi_opc));
2138
2139 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
2140 {
2141 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
2142 if (for_eh)
2143 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2144 ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0),
2145 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr),
2146 false, NULL);
2147 else
2148 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2149 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr, NULL);
2150 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2151 break;
2152
2153 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
2154 dw2_asm_output_delta (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2155 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2156 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2157 break;
2158
2159 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
2160 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2161 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2162 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2163 break;
2164
2165 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
2166 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2167 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2168 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2169 break;
2170
2171 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
2172 dw2_asm_output_delta (8, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2173 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2174 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2175 break;
2176
2177 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
2178 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
2179 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2180 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2181 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2182 break;
2183
2184 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
2185 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
2186 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2187 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2188 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2189 break;
2190
2191 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
2192 case DW_CFA_undefined:
2193 case DW_CFA_same_value:
2194 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
2195 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2196 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2197 break;
2198
2199 case DW_CFA_register:
2200 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2201 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2202 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2203 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2204 break;
2205
2206 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
2207 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
2208 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2209 break;
2210
2211 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
2212 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2213 break;
2214
2215 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
2216 break;
2217
2218 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
2219 case DW_CFA_expression:
2220 output_cfa_loc (cfi);
2221 break;
2222
2223 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
2224 /* Obsoleted by DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf. */
2225 gcc_unreachable ();
2226
2227 default:
2228 break;
2229 }
2230 }
2231 }
2232
2233 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
2234 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
2235 location of saved registers. */
2236
2237 static void
2238 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
2239 {
2240 unsigned int i;
2241 dw_fde_ref fde;
2242 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
2243 char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
2244 bool any_lsda_needed = false;
2245 char augmentation[6];
2246 int augmentation_size;
2247 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2248 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2249 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2250 int return_reg;
2251
2252 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
2253 if (fde_table_in_use == 0)
2254 return;
2255
2256 /* If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to emit an empty label for
2257 an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted. We want to avoid
2258 having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to is
2259 discarded. Example where this matters: a primary function
2260 template in C++ requires EH information, but an explicit
2261 specialization doesn't. */
2262 if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
2263 && ! flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables
2264 && flag_exceptions
2265 && for_eh)
2266 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2267 if ((fde_table[i].nothrow || fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2268 && !fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda
2269 && ! DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2270 targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde_table[i].decl,
2271 for_eh, /* empty */ 1);
2272
2273 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't
2274 emit any EH unwind information. Note that if exceptions aren't
2275 enabled, we won't have collected nothrow information, and if we
2276 asked for asynchronous tables, we always want this info. */
2277 if (for_eh)
2278 {
2279 bool any_eh_needed = !flag_exceptions || flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables;
2280
2281 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2282 if (fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda)
2283 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
2284 else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2285 any_eh_needed = true;
2286 else if (! fde_table[i].nothrow
2287 && ! fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2288 any_eh_needed = true;
2289
2290 if (! any_eh_needed)
2291 return;
2292 }
2293
2294 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
2295 if (flag_debug_asm)
2296 app_enable ();
2297
2298 if (for_eh)
2299 switch_to_eh_frame_section ();
2300 else
2301 {
2302 if (!debug_frame_section)
2303 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
2304 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
2305 switch_to_section (debug_frame_section);
2306 }
2307
2308 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
2309 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
2310
2311 /* Output the CIE. */
2312 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
2313 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
2314 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
2315 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
2316 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
2317 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
2318 "Length of Common Information Entry");
2319 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
2320
2321 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
2322 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
2323 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
2324 (for_eh ? 0 : DWARF_CIE_ID),
2325 "CIE Identifier Tag");
2326
2327 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_CIE_VERSION, "CIE Version");
2328
2329 augmentation[0] = 0;
2330 augmentation_size = 0;
2331 if (for_eh)
2332 {
2333 char *p;
2334
2335 /* Augmentation:
2336 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
2337 augmentation section.
2338 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
2339 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
2340 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
2341 FDE code pointers.
2342 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
2343 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
2344
2345 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
2346 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
2347 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
2348
2349 p = augmentation + 1;
2350 if (eh_personality_libfunc)
2351 {
2352 *p++ = 'P';
2353 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
2354 assemble_external_libcall (eh_personality_libfunc);
2355 }
2356 if (any_lsda_needed)
2357 {
2358 *p++ = 'L';
2359 augmentation_size += 1;
2360 }
2361 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
2362 {
2363 *p++ = 'R';
2364 augmentation_size += 1;
2365 }
2366 if (p > augmentation + 1)
2367 {
2368 augmentation[0] = 'z';
2369 *p = '\0';
2370 }
2371
2372 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
2373 if (eh_personality_libfunc && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2374 {
2375 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
2376 + 4 /* CIE Id */
2377 + 1 /* CIE version */
2378 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
2379 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
2380 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
2381 + 1 /* RA column */
2382 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
2383 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
2384 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2385
2386 augmentation_size += pad;
2387
2388 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
2389 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
2390 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
2391 }
2392 }
2393
2394 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
2395 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
2396 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
2397 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
2398
2399 return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
2400 if (DW_CIE_VERSION == 1)
2401 dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
2402 else
2403 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
2404
2405 if (augmentation[0])
2406 {
2407 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
2408 if (eh_personality_libfunc)
2409 {
2410 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
2411 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
2412 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
2413 eh_personality_libfunc,
2414 true, NULL);
2415 }
2416
2417 if (any_lsda_needed)
2418 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
2419 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
2420
2421 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
2422 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
2423 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
2424 }
2425
2426 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2427 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
2428
2429 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
2430 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2431 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
2432 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2433
2434 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
2435 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2436 {
2437 fde = &fde_table[i];
2438
2439 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
2440 if (for_eh && !flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && flag_exceptions
2441 && (fde->nothrow || fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2442 && ! (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2443 && !fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2444 continue;
2445
2446 targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh, /* empty */ 0);
2447 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2448 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2449 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2450 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
2451 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
2452 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
2453 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
2454 "FDE Length");
2455 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
2456
2457 if (for_eh)
2458 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
2459 else
2460 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
2461 debug_frame_section, "FDE CIE offset");
2462
2463 if (for_eh)
2464 {
2465 if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
2466 {
2467 rtx sym_ref2 = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
2468 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label);
2469 rtx sym_ref3= gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
2470 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label);
2471 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref2) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2472 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref3) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2473 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref3, false,
2474 "FDE initial location");
2475 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2476 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label,
2477 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2478 "FDE address range");
2479 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref2, false,
2480 "FDE initial location");
2481 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2482 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label,
2483 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2484 "FDE address range");
2485 }
2486 else
2487 {
2488 rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, fde->dw_fde_begin);
2489 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2490 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding,
2491 sym_ref,
2492 false,
2493 "FDE initial location");
2494 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2495 fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2496 "FDE address range");
2497 }
2498 }
2499 else
2500 {
2501 if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
2502 {
2503 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2504 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2505 "FDE initial location");
2506 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2507 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label,
2508 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2509 "FDE address range");
2510 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2511 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2512 "FDE initial location");
2513 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2514 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label,
2515 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2516 "FDE address range");
2517 }
2518 else
2519 {
2520 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2521 "FDE initial location");
2522 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2523 fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2524 "FDE address range");
2525 }
2526 }
2527
2528 if (augmentation[0])
2529 {
2530 if (any_lsda_needed)
2531 {
2532 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
2533
2534 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2535 {
2536 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
2537 + 4 /* CIE offset */
2538 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
2539 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
2540 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2541
2542 size += pad;
2543 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
2544 }
2545
2546 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
2547
2548 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2549 {
2550 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, "LLSDA",
2551 fde->funcdef_number);
2552 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2553 lsda_encoding, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
2554 false, "Language Specific Data Area");
2555 }
2556 else
2557 {
2558 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2559 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
2560 dw2_asm_output_data
2561 (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
2562 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
2563 }
2564 }
2565 else
2566 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
2567 }
2568
2569 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with
2570 this FDE. */
2571 fde->dw_fde_current_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
2572 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2573 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
2574
2575 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
2576 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2577 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
2578 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2579 }
2580
2581 if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
2582 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
2583 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2584 /* Work around Irix 6 assembler bug whereby labels at the end of a section
2585 get a value of 0. Putting .align 0 after the label fixes it. */
2586 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, 0);
2587 #endif
2588
2589 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
2590 if (flag_debug_asm)
2591 app_disable ();
2592 }
2593
2594 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
2595 the prologue. */
2596
2597 void
2598 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2599 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2600 {
2601 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2602 char * dup_label;
2603 dw_fde_ref fde;
2604
2605 current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
2606
2607 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2608 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c
2609 for call-site information. We must emit this label if it might
2610 be used. */
2611 if ((! flag_exceptions || USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
2612 && ! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2613 return;
2614 #else
2615 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2616 return;
2617 #endif
2618
2619 switch_to_section (function_section (current_function_decl));
2620 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2621 current_function_funcdef_no);
2622 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2623 current_function_funcdef_no);
2624 dup_label = xstrdup (label);
2625 current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
2626
2627 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2628 /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
2629 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2630 return;
2631 #endif
2632
2633 /* Expand the fde table if necessary. */
2634 if (fde_table_in_use == fde_table_allocated)
2635 {
2636 fde_table_allocated += FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2637 fde_table = ggc_realloc (fde_table,
2638 fde_table_allocated * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2639 memset (fde_table + fde_table_in_use, 0,
2640 FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2641 }
2642
2643 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
2644 current_funcdef_fde = fde_table_in_use;
2645
2646 /* Add the new FDE at the end of the fde_table. */
2647 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use++];
2648 fde->decl = current_function_decl;
2649 fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
2650 fde->dw_fde_current_label = dup_label;
2651 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = NULL;
2652 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = NULL;
2653 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = NULL;
2654 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = NULL;
2655 fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = false;
2656 fde->dw_fde_end = NULL;
2657 fde->dw_fde_cfi = NULL;
2658 fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
2659 fde->nothrow = TREE_NOTHROW (current_function_decl);
2660 fde->uses_eh_lsda = crtl->uses_eh_lsda;
2661 fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = crtl->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
2662
2663 args_size = old_args_size = 0;
2664
2665 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
2666 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
2667 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2668 if (file)
2669 dwarf2out_source_line (line, file);
2670 #endif
2671 }
2672
2673 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
2674 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
2675 been generated. */
2676
2677 void
2678 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2679 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2680 {
2681 dw_fde_ref fde;
2682 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2683
2684 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
2685 function. */
2686 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
2687 current_function_funcdef_no);
2688 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
2689 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
2690 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
2691 }
2692
2693 void
2694 dwarf2out_frame_init (void)
2695 {
2696 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the fde_table. */
2697 fde_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2698 fde_table_allocated = FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2699 fde_table_in_use = 0;
2700
2701 /* Generate the CFA instructions common to all FDE's. Do it now for the
2702 sake of lookup_cfa. */
2703
2704 /* On entry, the Canonical Frame Address is at SP. */
2705 dwarf2out_def_cfa (NULL, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET);
2706
2707 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
2708 if (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO || DWARF2_FRAME_INFO)
2709 initial_return_save (INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX);
2710 #endif
2711 }
2712
2713 void
2714 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
2715 {
2716 /* Output call frame information. */
2717 if (DWARF2_FRAME_INFO)
2718 output_call_frame_info (0);
2719
2720 #ifndef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2721 /* Output another copy for the unwinder. */
2722 if (! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS && (flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions))
2723 output_call_frame_info (1);
2724 #endif
2725 }
2726
2727 /* Note that the current function section is being used for code. */
2728
2729 static void
2730 dwarf2out_note_section_used (void)
2731 {
2732 section *sec = current_function_section ();
2733 if (sec == text_section)
2734 text_section_used = true;
2735 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
2736 cold_text_section_used = true;
2737 }
2738
2739 void
2740 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
2741 {
2742 dw_fde_ref fde;
2743
2744 gcc_assert (cfun);
2745
2746 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
2747 fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = true;
2748 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = crtl->subsections.hot_section_label;
2749 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
2750 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
2751 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
2752 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
2753
2754 /* Reset the current label on switching text sections, so that we
2755 don't attempt to advance_loc4 between labels in different sections. */
2756 fde->dw_fde_current_label = NULL;
2757
2758 /* There is no need to mark used sections when not debugging. */
2759 if (cold_text_section != NULL)
2760 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
2761 }
2762 #endif
2763 \f
2764 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
2765 for emitting location expressions. */
2766
2767 /* Data about a single source file. */
2768 struct dwarf_file_data GTY(())
2769 {
2770 const char * filename;
2771 int emitted_number;
2772 };
2773
2774 /* We need some way to distinguish DW_OP_addr with a direct symbol
2775 relocation from DW_OP_addr with a dtp-relative symbol relocation. */
2776 #define INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr (0x100 + DW_OP_addr)
2777
2778
2779 typedef struct dw_val_struct *dw_val_ref;
2780 typedef struct die_struct *dw_die_ref;
2781 typedef const struct die_struct *const_dw_die_ref;
2782 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct *dw_loc_descr_ref;
2783 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct *dw_loc_list_ref;
2784
2785 /* Each DIE may have a series of attribute/value pairs. Values
2786 can take on several forms. The forms that are used in this
2787 implementation are listed below. */
2788
2789 enum dw_val_class
2790 {
2791 dw_val_class_addr,
2792 dw_val_class_offset,
2793 dw_val_class_loc,
2794 dw_val_class_loc_list,
2795 dw_val_class_range_list,
2796 dw_val_class_const,
2797 dw_val_class_unsigned_const,
2798 dw_val_class_long_long,
2799 dw_val_class_vec,
2800 dw_val_class_flag,
2801 dw_val_class_die_ref,
2802 dw_val_class_fde_ref,
2803 dw_val_class_lbl_id,
2804 dw_val_class_lineptr,
2805 dw_val_class_str,
2806 dw_val_class_macptr,
2807 dw_val_class_file
2808 };
2809
2810 /* Describe a double word constant value. */
2811 /* ??? Every instance of long_long in the code really means CONST_DOUBLE. */
2812
2813 typedef struct dw_long_long_struct GTY(())
2814 {
2815 unsigned long hi;
2816 unsigned long low;
2817 }
2818 dw_long_long_const;
2819
2820 /* Describe a floating point constant value, or a vector constant value. */
2821
2822 typedef struct dw_vec_struct GTY(())
2823 {
2824 unsigned char * GTY((length ("%h.length"))) array;
2825 unsigned length;
2826 unsigned elt_size;
2827 }
2828 dw_vec_const;
2829
2830 /* The dw_val_node describes an attribute's value, as it is
2831 represented internally. */
2832
2833 typedef struct dw_val_struct GTY(())
2834 {
2835 enum dw_val_class val_class;
2836 union dw_val_struct_union
2837 {
2838 rtx GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_addr"))) val_addr;
2839 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_offset"))) val_offset;
2840 dw_loc_list_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc_list"))) val_loc_list;
2841 dw_loc_descr_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc"))) val_loc;
2842 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((default)) val_int;
2843 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_unsigned_const"))) val_unsigned;
2844 dw_long_long_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_long_long"))) val_long_long;
2845 dw_vec_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_vec"))) val_vec;
2846 struct dw_val_die_union
2847 {
2848 dw_die_ref die;
2849 int external;
2850 } GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_die_ref"))) val_die_ref;
2851 unsigned GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_fde_ref"))) val_fde_index;
2852 struct indirect_string_node * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_str"))) val_str;
2853 char * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_lbl_id"))) val_lbl_id;
2854 unsigned char GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_flag"))) val_flag;
2855 struct dwarf_file_data * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_file"))) val_file;
2856 }
2857 GTY ((desc ("%1.val_class"))) v;
2858 }
2859 dw_val_node;
2860
2861 /* Locations in memory are described using a sequence of stack machine
2862 operations. */
2863
2864 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct GTY(())
2865 {
2866 dw_loc_descr_ref dw_loc_next;
2867 enum dwarf_location_atom dw_loc_opc;
2868 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd1;
2869 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd2;
2870 int dw_loc_addr;
2871 }
2872 dw_loc_descr_node;
2873
2874 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
2875 so you can track variables that are in different places over
2876 their entire life. */
2877 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct GTY(())
2878 {
2879 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
2880 const char *begin; /* Label for begin address of range */
2881 const char *end; /* Label for end address of range */
2882 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
2883 Only on head of list */
2884 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
2885 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
2886 } dw_loc_list_node;
2887
2888 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2889
2890 static const char *dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned);
2891 static dw_loc_descr_ref new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom,
2892 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
2893 static void add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref);
2894 static unsigned long size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2895 static unsigned long size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2896 static void output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2897 static void output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2898
2899 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
2900
2901 static const char *
2902 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
2903 {
2904 switch (op)
2905 {
2906 case DW_OP_addr:
2907 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
2908 return "DW_OP_addr";
2909 case DW_OP_deref:
2910 return "DW_OP_deref";
2911 case DW_OP_const1u:
2912 return "DW_OP_const1u";
2913 case DW_OP_const1s:
2914 return "DW_OP_const1s";
2915 case DW_OP_const2u:
2916 return "DW_OP_const2u";
2917 case DW_OP_const2s:
2918 return "DW_OP_const2s";
2919 case DW_OP_const4u:
2920 return "DW_OP_const4u";
2921 case DW_OP_const4s:
2922 return "DW_OP_const4s";
2923 case DW_OP_const8u:
2924 return "DW_OP_const8u";
2925 case DW_OP_const8s:
2926 return "DW_OP_const8s";
2927 case DW_OP_constu:
2928 return "DW_OP_constu";
2929 case DW_OP_consts:
2930 return "DW_OP_consts";
2931 case DW_OP_dup:
2932 return "DW_OP_dup";
2933 case DW_OP_drop:
2934 return "DW_OP_drop";
2935 case DW_OP_over:
2936 return "DW_OP_over";
2937 case DW_OP_pick:
2938 return "DW_OP_pick";
2939 case DW_OP_swap:
2940 return "DW_OP_swap";
2941 case DW_OP_rot:
2942 return "DW_OP_rot";
2943 case DW_OP_xderef:
2944 return "DW_OP_xderef";
2945 case DW_OP_abs:
2946 return "DW_OP_abs";
2947 case DW_OP_and:
2948 return "DW_OP_and";
2949 case DW_OP_div:
2950 return "DW_OP_div";
2951 case DW_OP_minus:
2952 return "DW_OP_minus";
2953 case DW_OP_mod:
2954 return "DW_OP_mod";
2955 case DW_OP_mul:
2956 return "DW_OP_mul";
2957 case DW_OP_neg:
2958 return "DW_OP_neg";
2959 case DW_OP_not:
2960 return "DW_OP_not";
2961 case DW_OP_or:
2962 return "DW_OP_or";
2963 case DW_OP_plus:
2964 return "DW_OP_plus";
2965 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2966 return "DW_OP_plus_uconst";
2967 case DW_OP_shl:
2968 return "DW_OP_shl";
2969 case DW_OP_shr:
2970 return "DW_OP_shr";
2971 case DW_OP_shra:
2972 return "DW_OP_shra";
2973 case DW_OP_xor:
2974 return "DW_OP_xor";
2975 case DW_OP_bra:
2976 return "DW_OP_bra";
2977 case DW_OP_eq:
2978 return "DW_OP_eq";
2979 case DW_OP_ge:
2980 return "DW_OP_ge";
2981 case DW_OP_gt:
2982 return "DW_OP_gt";
2983 case DW_OP_le:
2984 return "DW_OP_le";
2985 case DW_OP_lt:
2986 return "DW_OP_lt";
2987 case DW_OP_ne:
2988 return "DW_OP_ne";
2989 case DW_OP_skip:
2990 return "DW_OP_skip";
2991 case DW_OP_lit0:
2992 return "DW_OP_lit0";
2993 case DW_OP_lit1:
2994 return "DW_OP_lit1";
2995 case DW_OP_lit2:
2996 return "DW_OP_lit2";
2997 case DW_OP_lit3:
2998 return "DW_OP_lit3";
2999 case DW_OP_lit4:
3000 return "DW_OP_lit4";
3001 case DW_OP_lit5:
3002 return "DW_OP_lit5";
3003 case DW_OP_lit6:
3004 return "DW_OP_lit6";
3005 case DW_OP_lit7:
3006 return "DW_OP_lit7";
3007 case DW_OP_lit8:
3008 return "DW_OP_lit8";
3009 case DW_OP_lit9:
3010 return "DW_OP_lit9";
3011 case DW_OP_lit10:
3012 return "DW_OP_lit10";
3013 case DW_OP_lit11:
3014 return "DW_OP_lit11";
3015 case DW_OP_lit12:
3016 return "DW_OP_lit12";
3017 case DW_OP_lit13:
3018 return "DW_OP_lit13";
3019 case DW_OP_lit14:
3020 return "DW_OP_lit14";
3021 case DW_OP_lit15:
3022 return "DW_OP_lit15";
3023 case DW_OP_lit16:
3024 return "DW_OP_lit16";
3025 case DW_OP_lit17:
3026 return "DW_OP_lit17";
3027 case DW_OP_lit18:
3028 return "DW_OP_lit18";
3029 case DW_OP_lit19:
3030 return "DW_OP_lit19";
3031 case DW_OP_lit20:
3032 return "DW_OP_lit20";
3033 case DW_OP_lit21:
3034 return "DW_OP_lit21";
3035 case DW_OP_lit22:
3036 return "DW_OP_lit22";
3037 case DW_OP_lit23:
3038 return "DW_OP_lit23";
3039 case DW_OP_lit24:
3040 return "DW_OP_lit24";
3041 case DW_OP_lit25:
3042 return "DW_OP_lit25";
3043 case DW_OP_lit26:
3044 return "DW_OP_lit26";
3045 case DW_OP_lit27:
3046 return "DW_OP_lit27";
3047 case DW_OP_lit28:
3048 return "DW_OP_lit28";
3049 case DW_OP_lit29:
3050 return "DW_OP_lit29";
3051 case DW_OP_lit30:
3052 return "DW_OP_lit30";
3053 case DW_OP_lit31:
3054 return "DW_OP_lit31";
3055 case DW_OP_reg0:
3056 return "DW_OP_reg0";
3057 case DW_OP_reg1:
3058 return "DW_OP_reg1";
3059 case DW_OP_reg2:
3060 return "DW_OP_reg2";
3061 case DW_OP_reg3:
3062 return "DW_OP_reg3";
3063 case DW_OP_reg4:
3064 return "DW_OP_reg4";
3065 case DW_OP_reg5:
3066 return "DW_OP_reg5";
3067 case DW_OP_reg6:
3068 return "DW_OP_reg6";
3069 case DW_OP_reg7:
3070 return "DW_OP_reg7";
3071 case DW_OP_reg8:
3072 return "DW_OP_reg8";
3073 case DW_OP_reg9:
3074 return "DW_OP_reg9";
3075 case DW_OP_reg10:
3076 return "DW_OP_reg10";
3077 case DW_OP_reg11:
3078 return "DW_OP_reg11";
3079 case DW_OP_reg12:
3080 return "DW_OP_reg12";
3081 case DW_OP_reg13:
3082 return "DW_OP_reg13";
3083 case DW_OP_reg14:
3084 return "DW_OP_reg14";
3085 case DW_OP_reg15:
3086 return "DW_OP_reg15";
3087 case DW_OP_reg16:
3088 return "DW_OP_reg16";
3089 case DW_OP_reg17:
3090 return "DW_OP_reg17";
3091 case DW_OP_reg18:
3092 return "DW_OP_reg18";
3093 case DW_OP_reg19:
3094 return "DW_OP_reg19";
3095 case DW_OP_reg20:
3096 return "DW_OP_reg20";
3097 case DW_OP_reg21:
3098 return "DW_OP_reg21";
3099 case DW_OP_reg22:
3100 return "DW_OP_reg22";
3101 case DW_OP_reg23:
3102 return "DW_OP_reg23";
3103 case DW_OP_reg24:
3104 return "DW_OP_reg24";
3105 case DW_OP_reg25:
3106 return "DW_OP_reg25";
3107 case DW_OP_reg26:
3108 return "DW_OP_reg26";
3109 case DW_OP_reg27:
3110 return "DW_OP_reg27";
3111 case DW_OP_reg28:
3112 return "DW_OP_reg28";
3113 case DW_OP_reg29:
3114 return "DW_OP_reg29";
3115 case DW_OP_reg30:
3116 return "DW_OP_reg30";
3117 case DW_OP_reg31:
3118 return "DW_OP_reg31";
3119 case DW_OP_breg0:
3120 return "DW_OP_breg0";
3121 case DW_OP_breg1:
3122 return "DW_OP_breg1";
3123 case DW_OP_breg2:
3124 return "DW_OP_breg2";
3125 case DW_OP_breg3:
3126 return "DW_OP_breg3";
3127 case DW_OP_breg4:
3128 return "DW_OP_breg4";
3129 case DW_OP_breg5:
3130 return "DW_OP_breg5";
3131 case DW_OP_breg6:
3132 return "DW_OP_breg6";
3133 case DW_OP_breg7:
3134 return "DW_OP_breg7";
3135 case DW_OP_breg8:
3136 return "DW_OP_breg8";
3137 case DW_OP_breg9:
3138 return "DW_OP_breg9";
3139 case DW_OP_breg10:
3140 return "DW_OP_breg10";
3141 case DW_OP_breg11:
3142 return "DW_OP_breg11";
3143 case DW_OP_breg12:
3144 return "DW_OP_breg12";
3145 case DW_OP_breg13:
3146 return "DW_OP_breg13";
3147 case DW_OP_breg14:
3148 return "DW_OP_breg14";
3149 case DW_OP_breg15:
3150 return "DW_OP_breg15";
3151 case DW_OP_breg16:
3152 return "DW_OP_breg16";
3153 case DW_OP_breg17:
3154 return "DW_OP_breg17";
3155 case DW_OP_breg18:
3156 return "DW_OP_breg18";
3157 case DW_OP_breg19:
3158 return "DW_OP_breg19";
3159 case DW_OP_breg20:
3160 return "DW_OP_breg20";
3161 case DW_OP_breg21:
3162 return "DW_OP_breg21";
3163 case DW_OP_breg22:
3164 return "DW_OP_breg22";
3165 case DW_OP_breg23:
3166 return "DW_OP_breg23";
3167 case DW_OP_breg24:
3168 return "DW_OP_breg24";
3169 case DW_OP_breg25:
3170 return "DW_OP_breg25";
3171 case DW_OP_breg26:
3172 return "DW_OP_breg26";
3173 case DW_OP_breg27:
3174 return "DW_OP_breg27";
3175 case DW_OP_breg28:
3176 return "DW_OP_breg28";
3177 case DW_OP_breg29:
3178 return "DW_OP_breg29";
3179 case DW_OP_breg30:
3180 return "DW_OP_breg30";
3181 case DW_OP_breg31:
3182 return "DW_OP_breg31";
3183 case DW_OP_regx:
3184 return "DW_OP_regx";
3185 case DW_OP_fbreg:
3186 return "DW_OP_fbreg";
3187 case DW_OP_bregx:
3188 return "DW_OP_bregx";
3189 case DW_OP_piece:
3190 return "DW_OP_piece";
3191 case DW_OP_deref_size:
3192 return "DW_OP_deref_size";
3193 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3194 return "DW_OP_xderef_size";
3195 case DW_OP_nop:
3196 return "DW_OP_nop";
3197 case DW_OP_push_object_address:
3198 return "DW_OP_push_object_address";
3199 case DW_OP_call2:
3200 return "DW_OP_call2";
3201 case DW_OP_call4:
3202 return "DW_OP_call4";
3203 case DW_OP_call_ref:
3204 return "DW_OP_call_ref";
3205 case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
3206 return "DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address";
3207 case DW_OP_GNU_uninit:
3208 return "DW_OP_GNU_uninit";
3209 default:
3210 return "OP_<unknown>";
3211 }
3212 }
3213
3214 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
3215 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
3216 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
3217
3218 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
3219 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
3220 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
3221 {
3222 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
3223
3224 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
3225 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
3226 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
3227 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
3228 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
3229
3230 return descr;
3231 }
3232
3233 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
3234
3235 static inline void
3236 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
3237 {
3238 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
3239
3240 /* Find the end of the chain. */
3241 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
3242 ;
3243
3244 *d = descr;
3245 }
3246
3247 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
3248
3249 static unsigned long
3250 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3251 {
3252 unsigned long size = 1;
3253
3254 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
3255 {
3256 case DW_OP_addr:
3257 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
3258 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
3259 break;
3260 case DW_OP_const1u:
3261 case DW_OP_const1s:
3262 size += 1;
3263 break;
3264 case DW_OP_const2u:
3265 case DW_OP_const2s:
3266 size += 2;
3267 break;
3268 case DW_OP_const4u:
3269 case DW_OP_const4s:
3270 size += 4;
3271 break;
3272 case DW_OP_const8u:
3273 case DW_OP_const8s:
3274 size += 8;
3275 break;
3276 case DW_OP_constu:
3277 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3278 break;
3279 case DW_OP_consts:
3280 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3281 break;
3282 case DW_OP_pick:
3283 size += 1;
3284 break;
3285 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3286 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3287 break;
3288 case DW_OP_skip:
3289 case DW_OP_bra:
3290 size += 2;
3291 break;
3292 case DW_OP_breg0:
3293 case DW_OP_breg1:
3294 case DW_OP_breg2:
3295 case DW_OP_breg3:
3296 case DW_OP_breg4:
3297 case DW_OP_breg5:
3298 case DW_OP_breg6:
3299 case DW_OP_breg7:
3300 case DW_OP_breg8:
3301 case DW_OP_breg9:
3302 case DW_OP_breg10:
3303 case DW_OP_breg11:
3304 case DW_OP_breg12:
3305 case DW_OP_breg13:
3306 case DW_OP_breg14:
3307 case DW_OP_breg15:
3308 case DW_OP_breg16:
3309 case DW_OP_breg17:
3310 case DW_OP_breg18:
3311 case DW_OP_breg19:
3312 case DW_OP_breg20:
3313 case DW_OP_breg21:
3314 case DW_OP_breg22:
3315 case DW_OP_breg23:
3316 case DW_OP_breg24:
3317 case DW_OP_breg25:
3318 case DW_OP_breg26:
3319 case DW_OP_breg27:
3320 case DW_OP_breg28:
3321 case DW_OP_breg29:
3322 case DW_OP_breg30:
3323 case DW_OP_breg31:
3324 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3325 break;
3326 case DW_OP_regx:
3327 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3328 break;
3329 case DW_OP_fbreg:
3330 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3331 break;
3332 case DW_OP_bregx:
3333 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3334 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
3335 break;
3336 case DW_OP_piece:
3337 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3338 break;
3339 case DW_OP_deref_size:
3340 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3341 size += 1;
3342 break;
3343 case DW_OP_call2:
3344 size += 2;
3345 break;
3346 case DW_OP_call4:
3347 size += 4;
3348 break;
3349 case DW_OP_call_ref:
3350 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
3351 break;
3352 default:
3353 break;
3354 }
3355
3356 return size;
3357 }
3358
3359 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
3360
3361 static unsigned long
3362 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3363 {
3364 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
3365 unsigned long size;
3366
3367 /* If there are no skip or bra opcodes, don't fill in the dw_loc_addr
3368 field, to avoid writing to a PCH file. */
3369 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
3370 {
3371 if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_skip || l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bra)
3372 break;
3373 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
3374 }
3375 if (! l)
3376 return size;
3377
3378 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
3379 {
3380 l->dw_loc_addr = size;
3381 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
3382 }
3383
3384 return size;
3385 }
3386
3387 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any). */
3388
3389 static void
3390 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3391 {
3392 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
3393 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
3394
3395 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
3396 {
3397 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3398 case DW_OP_addr:
3399 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
3400 break;
3401 case DW_OP_const2u:
3402 case DW_OP_const2s:
3403 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3404 break;
3405 case DW_OP_const4u:
3406 case DW_OP_const4s:
3407 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3408 break;
3409 case DW_OP_const8u:
3410 case DW_OP_const8s:
3411 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG >= 64);
3412 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3413 break;
3414 case DW_OP_skip:
3415 case DW_OP_bra:
3416 {
3417 int offset;
3418
3419 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
3420 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
3421
3422 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
3423 }
3424 break;
3425 #else
3426 case DW_OP_addr:
3427 case DW_OP_const2u:
3428 case DW_OP_const2s:
3429 case DW_OP_const4u:
3430 case DW_OP_const4s:
3431 case DW_OP_const8u:
3432 case DW_OP_const8s:
3433 case DW_OP_skip:
3434 case DW_OP_bra:
3435 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
3436 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
3437 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
3438 only doing unwinding. */
3439 gcc_unreachable ();
3440 #endif
3441 case DW_OP_const1u:
3442 case DW_OP_const1s:
3443 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3444 break;
3445 case DW_OP_constu:
3446 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3447 break;
3448 case DW_OP_consts:
3449 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3450 break;
3451 case DW_OP_pick:
3452 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3453 break;
3454 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3455 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3456 break;
3457 case DW_OP_breg0:
3458 case DW_OP_breg1:
3459 case DW_OP_breg2:
3460 case DW_OP_breg3:
3461 case DW_OP_breg4:
3462 case DW_OP_breg5:
3463 case DW_OP_breg6:
3464 case DW_OP_breg7:
3465 case DW_OP_breg8:
3466 case DW_OP_breg9:
3467 case DW_OP_breg10:
3468 case DW_OP_breg11:
3469 case DW_OP_breg12:
3470 case DW_OP_breg13:
3471 case DW_OP_breg14:
3472 case DW_OP_breg15:
3473 case DW_OP_breg16:
3474 case DW_OP_breg17:
3475 case DW_OP_breg18:
3476 case DW_OP_breg19:
3477 case DW_OP_breg20:
3478 case DW_OP_breg21:
3479 case DW_OP_breg22:
3480 case DW_OP_breg23:
3481 case DW_OP_breg24:
3482 case DW_OP_breg25:
3483 case DW_OP_breg26:
3484 case DW_OP_breg27:
3485 case DW_OP_breg28:
3486 case DW_OP_breg29:
3487 case DW_OP_breg30:
3488 case DW_OP_breg31:
3489 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3490 break;
3491 case DW_OP_regx:
3492 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3493 break;
3494 case DW_OP_fbreg:
3495 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3496 break;
3497 case DW_OP_bregx:
3498 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3499 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
3500 break;
3501 case DW_OP_piece:
3502 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3503 break;
3504 case DW_OP_deref_size:
3505 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3506 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3507 break;
3508
3509 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
3510 if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
3511 {
3512 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
3513 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
3514 val1->v.val_addr);
3515 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3516 }
3517 else
3518 gcc_unreachable ();
3519 break;
3520
3521 default:
3522 /* Other codes have no operands. */
3523 break;
3524 }
3525 }
3526
3527 /* Output a sequence of location operations. */
3528
3529 static void
3530 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3531 {
3532 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
3533 {
3534 /* Output the opcode. */
3535 dw2_asm_output_data (1, loc->dw_loc_opc,
3536 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (loc->dw_loc_opc));
3537
3538 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
3539 output_loc_operands (loc);
3540 }
3541 }
3542
3543 /* This routine will generate the correct assembly data for a location
3544 description based on a cfi entry with a complex address. */
3545
3546 static void
3547 output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
3548 {
3549 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
3550 unsigned long size;
3551
3552 /* Output the size of the block. */
3553 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
3554 size = size_of_locs (loc);
3555 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, NULL);
3556
3557 /* Now output the operations themselves. */
3558 output_loc_sequence (loc);
3559 }
3560
3561 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
3562 dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
3563 expression. */
3564
3565 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
3566 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
3567 {
3568 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head, *tmp;
3569
3570 offset += cfa->offset;
3571
3572 if (cfa->indirect)
3573 {
3574 if (cfa->base_offset)
3575 {
3576 if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3577 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset, 0);
3578 else
3579 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
3580 }
3581 else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3582 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
3583 else
3584 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
3585
3586 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
3587 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
3588 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
3589 if (offset != 0)
3590 {
3591 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
3592 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
3593 }
3594 }
3595 else
3596 {
3597 if (offset == 0)
3598 if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3599 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
3600 else
3601 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
3602 else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3603 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, offset, 0);
3604 else
3605 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, offset);
3606 }
3607
3608 return head;
3609 }
3610
3611 /* This function fills in aa dw_cfa_location structure from a dwarf location
3612 descriptor sequence. */
3613
3614 static void
3615 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *cfa, struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc)
3616 {
3617 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *ptr;
3618 cfa->offset = 0;
3619 cfa->base_offset = 0;
3620 cfa->indirect = 0;
3621 cfa->reg = -1;
3622
3623 for (ptr = loc; ptr != NULL; ptr = ptr->dw_loc_next)
3624 {
3625 enum dwarf_location_atom op = ptr->dw_loc_opc;
3626
3627 switch (op)
3628 {
3629 case DW_OP_reg0:
3630 case DW_OP_reg1:
3631 case DW_OP_reg2:
3632 case DW_OP_reg3:
3633 case DW_OP_reg4:
3634 case DW_OP_reg5:
3635 case DW_OP_reg6:
3636 case DW_OP_reg7:
3637 case DW_OP_reg8:
3638 case DW_OP_reg9:
3639 case DW_OP_reg10:
3640 case DW_OP_reg11:
3641 case DW_OP_reg12:
3642 case DW_OP_reg13:
3643 case DW_OP_reg14:
3644 case DW_OP_reg15:
3645 case DW_OP_reg16:
3646 case DW_OP_reg17:
3647 case DW_OP_reg18:
3648 case DW_OP_reg19:
3649 case DW_OP_reg20:
3650 case DW_OP_reg21:
3651 case DW_OP_reg22:
3652 case DW_OP_reg23:
3653 case DW_OP_reg24:
3654 case DW_OP_reg25:
3655 case DW_OP_reg26:
3656 case DW_OP_reg27:
3657 case DW_OP_reg28:
3658 case DW_OP_reg29:
3659 case DW_OP_reg30:
3660 case DW_OP_reg31:
3661 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_reg0;
3662 break;
3663 case DW_OP_regx:
3664 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3665 break;
3666 case DW_OP_breg0:
3667 case DW_OP_breg1:
3668 case DW_OP_breg2:
3669 case DW_OP_breg3:
3670 case DW_OP_breg4:
3671 case DW_OP_breg5:
3672 case DW_OP_breg6:
3673 case DW_OP_breg7:
3674 case DW_OP_breg8:
3675 case DW_OP_breg9:
3676 case DW_OP_breg10:
3677 case DW_OP_breg11:
3678 case DW_OP_breg12:
3679 case DW_OP_breg13:
3680 case DW_OP_breg14:
3681 case DW_OP_breg15:
3682 case DW_OP_breg16:
3683 case DW_OP_breg17:
3684 case DW_OP_breg18:
3685 case DW_OP_breg19:
3686 case DW_OP_breg20:
3687 case DW_OP_breg21:
3688 case DW_OP_breg22:
3689 case DW_OP_breg23:
3690 case DW_OP_breg24:
3691 case DW_OP_breg25:
3692 case DW_OP_breg26:
3693 case DW_OP_breg27:
3694 case DW_OP_breg28:
3695 case DW_OP_breg29:
3696 case DW_OP_breg30:
3697 case DW_OP_breg31:
3698 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_breg0;
3699 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3700 break;
3701 case DW_OP_bregx:
3702 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3703 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
3704 break;
3705 case DW_OP_deref:
3706 cfa->indirect = 1;
3707 break;
3708 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3709 cfa->offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
3710 break;
3711 default:
3712 internal_error ("DW_LOC_OP %s not implemented",
3713 dwarf_stack_op_name (ptr->dw_loc_opc));
3714 }
3715 }
3716 }
3717 #endif /* .debug_frame support */
3718 \f
3719 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
3720 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3721
3722 /* .debug_str support. */
3723 static int output_indirect_string (void **, void *);
3724
3725 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
3726 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
3727 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
3728 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
3729 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
3730 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
3731 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3732 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3733 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree);
3734 static void dwarf2out_global_decl (tree);
3735 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
3736 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree);
3737 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
3738 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx);
3739 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
3740
3741 /* The debug hooks structure. */
3742
3743 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
3744 {
3745 dwarf2out_init,
3746 dwarf2out_finish,
3747 dwarf2out_define,
3748 dwarf2out_undef,
3749 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
3750 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
3751 dwarf2out_begin_block,
3752 dwarf2out_end_block,
3753 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
3754 dwarf2out_source_line,
3755 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
3756 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_prologue */
3757 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
3758 dwarf2out_begin_function,
3759 debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
3760 dwarf2out_decl, /* function_decl */
3761 dwarf2out_global_decl,
3762 dwarf2out_type_decl, /* type_decl */
3763 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
3764 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
3765 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
3766 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
3767 something tries to reference them. */
3768 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
3769 debug_nothing_rtx, /* label */
3770 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
3771 dwarf2out_var_location,
3772 dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
3773 1 /* start_end_main_source_file */
3774 };
3775 #endif
3776 \f
3777 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
3778 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
3779 throughout the remainder of this file. */
3780
3781 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
3782 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
3783 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
3784 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
3785
3786 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
3787 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
3788
3789 typedef long int dw_offset;
3790
3791 /* Define typedefs here to avoid circular dependencies. */
3792
3793 typedef struct dw_attr_struct *dw_attr_ref;
3794 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct *dw_line_info_ref;
3795 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct *dw_separate_line_info_ref;
3796 typedef struct pubname_struct *pubname_ref;
3797 typedef struct dw_ranges_struct *dw_ranges_ref;
3798 typedef struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct *dw_ranges_by_label_ref;
3799
3800 /* Each entry in the line_info_table maintains the file and
3801 line number associated with the label generated for that
3802 entry. The label gives the PC value associated with
3803 the line number entry. */
3804
3805 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct GTY(())
3806 {
3807 unsigned long dw_file_num;
3808 unsigned long dw_line_num;
3809 }
3810 dw_line_info_entry;
3811
3812 /* Line information for functions in separate sections; each one gets its
3813 own sequence. */
3814 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct GTY(())
3815 {
3816 unsigned long dw_file_num;
3817 unsigned long dw_line_num;
3818 unsigned long function;
3819 }
3820 dw_separate_line_info_entry;
3821
3822 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
3823 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
3824 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
3825
3826 typedef struct dw_attr_struct GTY(())
3827 {
3828 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
3829 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
3830 }
3831 dw_attr_node;
3832
3833 DEF_VEC_O(dw_attr_node);
3834 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(dw_attr_node,gc);
3835
3836 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure. DIEs form a tree.
3837 The children of each node form a circular list linked by
3838 die_sib. die_child points to the node *before* the "first" child node. */
3839
3840 typedef struct die_struct GTY(())
3841 {
3842 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
3843 char *die_symbol;
3844 VEC(dw_attr_node,gc) * die_attr;
3845 dw_die_ref die_parent;
3846 dw_die_ref die_child;
3847 dw_die_ref die_sib;
3848 dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
3849 dw_offset die_offset;
3850 unsigned long die_abbrev;
3851 int die_mark;
3852 /* Die is used and must not be pruned as unused. */
3853 int die_perennial_p;
3854 unsigned int decl_id;
3855 }
3856 die_node;
3857
3858 /* Evaluate 'expr' while 'c' is set to each child of DIE in order. */
3859 #define FOR_EACH_CHILD(die, c, expr) do { \
3860 c = die->die_child; \
3861 if (c) do { \
3862 c = c->die_sib; \
3863 expr; \
3864 } while (c != die->die_child); \
3865 } while (0)
3866
3867 /* The pubname structure */
3868
3869 typedef struct pubname_struct GTY(())
3870 {
3871 dw_die_ref die;
3872 const char *name;
3873 }
3874 pubname_entry;
3875
3876 DEF_VEC_O(pubname_entry);
3877 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(pubname_entry, gc);
3878
3879 struct dw_ranges_struct GTY(())
3880 {
3881 /* If this is positive, it's a block number, otherwise it's a
3882 bitwise-negated index into dw_ranges_by_label. */
3883 int num;
3884 };
3885
3886 struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct GTY(())
3887 {
3888 const char *begin;
3889 const char *end;
3890 };
3891
3892 /* The limbo die list structure. */
3893 typedef struct limbo_die_struct GTY(())
3894 {
3895 dw_die_ref die;
3896 tree created_for;
3897 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
3898 }
3899 limbo_die_node;
3900
3901 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
3902 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
3903 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
3904 #endif
3905
3906 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
3907 implicitly generated for a tagged type.
3908
3909 Note that unlike the gcc front end (which generates a NULL named
3910 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type, and
3911 each function type node created) the g++ front end generates a
3912 _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
3913 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
3914 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. */
3915
3916 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
3917 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
3918 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
3919 && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)) \
3920 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
3921 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
3922 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
3923 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
3924 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
3925 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
3926
3927 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
3928 language, and compiler version. */
3929
3930 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
3931 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3932 (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
3933
3934 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
3935 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
3936
3937 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
3938 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
3939 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3940 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3941 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
3942
3943 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
3944 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
3945 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
3946 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3947 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3948 - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
3949
3950 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
3951 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3952 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
3953 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
3954 #else
3955 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
3956 #endif
3957 #endif
3958
3959 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
3960 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
3961 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
3962
3963 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
3964 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE 10
3965
3966 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
3967 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
3968
3969 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
3970 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
3971 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
3972 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
3973 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
3974
3975 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3976 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
3977 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
3978 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
3979 #endif
3980
3981 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
3982 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref comp_unit_die;
3983
3984 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
3985 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
3986
3987 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
3988 static GTY((param_is (struct dwarf_file_data))) htab_t file_table;
3989
3990 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
3991 The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl. */
3992 static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct))) htab_t decl_die_table;
3993
3994 /* Node of the variable location list. */
3995 struct var_loc_node GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next")))
3996 {
3997 rtx GTY (()) var_loc_note;
3998 const char * GTY (()) label;
3999 const char * GTY (()) section_label;
4000 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
4001 };
4002
4003 /* Variable location list. */
4004 struct var_loc_list_def GTY (())
4005 {
4006 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
4007
4008 /* Do not mark the last element of the chained list because
4009 it is marked through the chain. */
4010 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
4011
4012 /* DECL_UID of the variable decl. */
4013 unsigned int decl_id;
4014 };
4015 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
4016
4017
4018 /* Table of decl location linked lists. */
4019 static GTY ((param_is (var_loc_list))) htab_t decl_loc_table;
4020
4021 /* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
4022 are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
4023 children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
4024 static GTY((length ("abbrev_die_table_allocated")))
4025 dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
4026
4027 /* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table. */
4028 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
4029
4030 /* Number of elements in type_die_table currently in use. */
4031 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
4032
4033 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
4034 abbrev_die_table. */
4035 #define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
4036
4037 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
4038 for each source code line in .text in the compilation unit. */
4039 static GTY((length ("line_info_table_allocated")))
4040 dw_line_info_ref line_info_table;
4041
4042 /* Number of elements currently allocated for line_info_table. */
4043 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_allocated;
4044
4045 /* Number of elements in line_info_table currently in use. */
4046 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_in_use;
4047
4048 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
4049 for each source code line outside of .text in the compilation unit. */
4050 static GTY ((length ("separate_line_info_table_allocated")))
4051 dw_separate_line_info_ref separate_line_info_table;
4052
4053 /* Number of elements currently allocated for separate_line_info_table. */
4054 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_allocated;
4055
4056 /* Number of elements in separate_line_info_table currently in use. */
4057 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_in_use;
4058
4059 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
4060 line_info_table. */
4061 #define LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT 1024
4062
4063 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
4064 accessible names. */
4065 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * pubname_table;
4066
4067 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
4068 accessible types. */
4069 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * pubtype_table;
4070
4071 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_arange info. */
4072 static GTY((length ("arange_table_allocated"))) dw_die_ref *arange_table;
4073
4074 /* Number of elements currently allocated for arange_table. */
4075 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_allocated;
4076
4077 /* Number of elements in arange_table currently in use. */
4078 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_in_use;
4079
4080 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
4081 arange_table. */
4082 #define ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
4083
4084 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
4085 static GTY ((length ("ranges_table_allocated"))) dw_ranges_ref ranges_table;
4086
4087 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table. */
4088 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
4089
4090 /* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use. */
4091 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
4092
4093 /* Array of pairs of labels referenced in ranges_table. */
4094 static GTY ((length ("ranges_by_label_allocated")))
4095 dw_ranges_by_label_ref ranges_by_label;
4096
4097 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_by_label. */
4098 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_by_label_allocated;
4099
4100 /* Number of elements in ranges_by_label currently in use. */
4101 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_by_label_in_use;
4102
4103 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
4104 ranges_table. */
4105 #define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
4106
4107 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
4108 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
4109
4110 /* Unique label counter. */
4111 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
4112
4113 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4114 /* Record whether the function being analyzed contains inlined functions. */
4115 static int current_function_has_inlines;
4116 #endif
4117 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
4118 static int comp_unit_has_inlines;
4119 #endif
4120
4121 /* The last file entry emitted by maybe_emit_file(). */
4122 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * last_emitted_file;
4123
4124 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym(). */
4125 static GTY(()) int label_num;
4126
4127 /* Cached result of previous call to lookup_filename. */
4128 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * file_table_last_lookup;
4129
4130 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4131
4132 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
4133 within the current function. */
4134 static HOST_WIDE_INT frame_pointer_fb_offset;
4135
4136 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
4137
4138 static int is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx);
4139 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
4140 static int is_tagged_type (const_tree);
4141 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
4142 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
4143 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
4144 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree);
4145 static tree block_ultimate_origin (const_tree);
4146 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
4147 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_ref);
4148 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_ref);
4149 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
4150 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_ref);
4151 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
4152 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_ref);
4153 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
4154 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref);
4155 static void add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned long,
4156 unsigned long);
4157 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
4158 unsigned int, unsigned char *);
4159 static hashval_t debug_str_do_hash (const void *);
4160 static int debug_str_eq (const void *, const void *);
4161 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4162 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_ref);
4163 static int AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref);
4164 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
4165 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4166 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_ref);
4167 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref);
4168 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref, int);
4169 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
4170 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
4171 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_ref);
4172 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4173 dw_loc_list_ref);
4174 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref);
4175 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx);
4176 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_ref);
4177 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4178 static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4179 static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4180 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4181 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
4182 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4183 unsigned long);
4184 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref);
4185 static dw_attr_ref get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4186 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
4187 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
4188 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4189 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4190 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4191 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4192 static bool is_c_family (void);
4193 static bool is_cxx (void);
4194 static bool is_java (void);
4195 static bool is_fortran (void);
4196 static bool is_ada (void);
4197 static void remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4198 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
4199 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4200 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
4201 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
4202 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4203 static hashval_t decl_die_table_hash (const void *);
4204 static int decl_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
4205 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
4206 static hashval_t decl_loc_table_hash (const void *);
4207 static int decl_loc_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
4208 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (const_tree);
4209 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4210 static void add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, struct var_loc_node *);
4211 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
4212 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
4213 static void print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *);
4214 static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4215 static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref);
4216 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
4217 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
4218 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
4219 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
4220 static int same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *, const dw_val_node *, int *);
4221 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref, dw_attr_ref, int *);
4222 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
4223 static int same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4224 static void compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref);
4225 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
4226 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
4227 static int is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref);
4228 static void assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref);
4229 static void break_out_includes (dw_die_ref);
4230 static hashval_t htab_cu_hash (const void *);
4231 static int htab_cu_eq (const void *, const void *);
4232 static void htab_cu_del (void *);
4233 static int check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned *);
4234 static void record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned);
4235 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
4236 static void build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref);
4237 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
4238 static int constant_size (long unsigned);
4239 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
4240 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
4241 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4242 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4243 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
4244 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry,gc) *);
4245 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
4246 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_ref);
4247 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_ref);
4248 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
4249 static void output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref);
4250 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
4251 static void output_compilation_unit_header (void);
4252 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int);
4253 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
4254 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
4255 static void add_pubname_string (const char *, dw_die_ref);
4256 static void add_pubtype (tree, dw_die_ref);
4257 static void output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry,gc) *);
4258 static void add_arange (tree, dw_die_ref);
4259 static void output_aranges (void);
4260 static unsigned int add_ranges_num (int);
4261 static unsigned int add_ranges (const_tree);
4262 static unsigned int add_ranges_by_labels (const char *, const char *);
4263 static void output_ranges (void);
4264 static void output_line_info (void);
4265 static void output_file_names (void);
4266 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree);
4267 static int is_base_type (tree);
4268 static bool is_subrange_type (const_tree);
4269 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4270 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
4271 static int type_is_enum (const_tree);
4272 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (const_rtx);
4273 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
4274 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum var_init_status);
4275 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int,
4276 enum var_init_status);
4277 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
4278 enum var_init_status);
4279 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
4280 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT,
4281 enum var_init_status);
4282 static int is_based_loc (const_rtx);
4283 static dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum machine_mode mode,
4284 enum var_init_status);
4285 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
4286 enum var_init_status);
4287 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx, enum var_init_status);
4288 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (tree, int);
4289 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree);
4290 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
4291 static tree field_type (const_tree);
4292 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree);
4293 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree);
4294 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree);
4295 static HOST_WIDE_INT field_byte_offset (const_tree);
4296 static void add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4297 dw_loc_descr_ref);
4298 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4299 static void add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
4300 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
4301 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
4302 static void insert_float (const_rtx, unsigned char *);
4303 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
4304 static void add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
4305 enum dwarf_attribute);
4306 static void tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4307 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
4308 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
4309 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree);
4310 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree);
4311 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4312 static void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4313 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4314 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4315 static void add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4316 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4317 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
4318 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
4319 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
4320 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
4321 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
4322 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
4323 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
4324 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
4325 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4326 static const char *type_tag (const_tree);
4327 static tree member_declared_type (const_tree);
4328 #if 0
4329 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
4330 #endif
4331 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4332 static void gen_descr_array_type_die (tree, struct array_descr_info *, dw_die_ref);
4333 #if 0
4334 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4335 #endif
4336 static void gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4337 static void gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4338 static void gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4339 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4340 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4341 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4342 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4343 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4344 static void gen_variable_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4345 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4346 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4347 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4348 static void gen_field_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4349 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4350 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
4351 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
4352 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4353 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref,
4354 enum debug_info_usage);
4355 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4356 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4357 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4358 static void gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4359 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4360 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4361 static int is_redundant_typedef (const_tree);
4362 static void gen_namespace_die (tree);
4363 static void gen_decl_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4364 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
4365 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
4366 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
4367 static void declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
4368 static struct dwarf_file_data * lookup_filename (const char *);
4369 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
4370 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
4371 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4372 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
4373 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
4374 const char *, const char *, unsigned);
4375 static void add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref,
4376 const char *, const char *,
4377 const char *);
4378 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
4379 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
4380
4381 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4382 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
4383 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
4384 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
4385 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
4386 static void prune_unused_types (void);
4387 static int maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data *fd);
4388
4389 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
4390 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
4391 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
4392 #endif
4393 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
4394 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
4395 #endif
4396 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
4397 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
4398 #endif
4399 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
4400 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
4401 #endif
4402 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
4403 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
4404 #endif
4405 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
4406 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
4407 #endif
4408 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
4409 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION ".debug_pubnames"
4410 #endif
4411 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
4412 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
4413 #endif
4414 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
4415 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
4416 #endif
4417
4418 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
4419 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
4420 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
4421 #endif
4422
4423 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
4424 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
4425 (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_debug_strings \
4426 ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1 \
4427 : SECTION_DEBUG)
4428
4429 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
4430 the section names themselves. */
4431
4432 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4433 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
4434 #endif
4435 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4436 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext_cold"
4437 #endif
4438 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
4439 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
4440 #endif
4441 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
4442 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
4443 #endif
4444 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
4445 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
4446 #endif
4447 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
4448 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
4449 #endif
4450 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
4451 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
4452 #endif
4453 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
4454 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
4455 #endif
4456
4457 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
4458 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
4459 options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
4460 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
4461 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
4462
4463 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4464 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4465 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4466 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4467 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4468 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4469 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4470 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4471 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4472 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4473
4474 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
4475 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
4476 #endif
4477 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
4478 #define COLD_END_LABEL "Letext_cold"
4479 #endif
4480 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
4481 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
4482 #endif
4483 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
4484 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
4485 #endif
4486 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
4487 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
4488 #endif
4489 #ifndef SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL
4490 #define SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL "LSM"
4491 #endif
4492
4493 \f
4494 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
4495 called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE. */
4496
4497 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
4498
4499 void
4500 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
4501 {
4502 demangle_name_func = func;
4503 }
4504
4505 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
4506
4507 static inline int
4508 is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx rtl)
4509 {
4510 return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
4511 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
4512 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
4513 }
4514
4515 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
4516 removed. */
4517
4518 static inline tree
4519 type_main_variant (tree type)
4520 {
4521 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4522
4523 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
4524 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
4525 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
4526 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
4527 here. */
4528 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
4529 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
4530 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4531
4532 return type;
4533 }
4534
4535 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
4536
4537 static inline int
4538 is_tagged_type (const_tree type)
4539 {
4540 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
4541
4542 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
4543 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
4544 }
4545
4546 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
4547
4548 static const char *
4549 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
4550 {
4551 switch (tag)
4552 {
4553 case DW_TAG_padding:
4554 return "DW_TAG_padding";
4555 case DW_TAG_array_type:
4556 return "DW_TAG_array_type";
4557 case DW_TAG_class_type:
4558 return "DW_TAG_class_type";
4559 case DW_TAG_entry_point:
4560 return "DW_TAG_entry_point";
4561 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
4562 return "DW_TAG_enumeration_type";
4563 case DW_TAG_formal_parameter:
4564 return "DW_TAG_formal_parameter";
4565 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
4566 return "DW_TAG_imported_declaration";
4567 case DW_TAG_label:
4568 return "DW_TAG_label";
4569 case DW_TAG_lexical_block:
4570 return "DW_TAG_lexical_block";
4571 case DW_TAG_member:
4572 return "DW_TAG_member";
4573 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
4574 return "DW_TAG_pointer_type";
4575 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
4576 return "DW_TAG_reference_type";
4577 case DW_TAG_compile_unit:
4578 return "DW_TAG_compile_unit";
4579 case DW_TAG_string_type:
4580 return "DW_TAG_string_type";
4581 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
4582 return "DW_TAG_structure_type";
4583 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
4584 return "DW_TAG_subroutine_type";
4585 case DW_TAG_typedef:
4586 return "DW_TAG_typedef";
4587 case DW_TAG_union_type:
4588 return "DW_TAG_union_type";
4589 case DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters:
4590 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters";
4591 case DW_TAG_variant:
4592 return "DW_TAG_variant";
4593 case DW_TAG_common_block:
4594 return "DW_TAG_common_block";
4595 case DW_TAG_common_inclusion:
4596 return "DW_TAG_common_inclusion";
4597 case DW_TAG_inheritance:
4598 return "DW_TAG_inheritance";
4599 case DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine:
4600 return "DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine";
4601 case DW_TAG_module:
4602 return "DW_TAG_module";
4603 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
4604 return "DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type";
4605 case DW_TAG_set_type:
4606 return "DW_TAG_set_type";
4607 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
4608 return "DW_TAG_subrange_type";
4609 case DW_TAG_with_stmt:
4610 return "DW_TAG_with_stmt";
4611 case DW_TAG_access_declaration:
4612 return "DW_TAG_access_declaration";
4613 case DW_TAG_base_type:
4614 return "DW_TAG_base_type";
4615 case DW_TAG_catch_block:
4616 return "DW_TAG_catch_block";
4617 case DW_TAG_const_type:
4618 return "DW_TAG_const_type";
4619 case DW_TAG_constant:
4620 return "DW_TAG_constant";
4621 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
4622 return "DW_TAG_enumerator";
4623 case DW_TAG_file_type:
4624 return "DW_TAG_file_type";
4625 case DW_TAG_friend:
4626 return "DW_TAG_friend";
4627 case DW_TAG_namelist:
4628 return "DW_TAG_namelist";
4629 case DW_TAG_namelist_item:
4630 return "DW_TAG_namelist_item";
4631 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
4632 return "DW_TAG_packed_type";
4633 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
4634 return "DW_TAG_subprogram";
4635 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
4636 return "DW_TAG_template_type_param";
4637 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
4638 return "DW_TAG_template_value_param";
4639 case DW_TAG_thrown_type:
4640 return "DW_TAG_thrown_type";
4641 case DW_TAG_try_block:
4642 return "DW_TAG_try_block";
4643 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
4644 return "DW_TAG_variant_part";
4645 case DW_TAG_variable:
4646 return "DW_TAG_variable";
4647 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
4648 return "DW_TAG_volatile_type";
4649 case DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure:
4650 return "DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure";
4651 case DW_TAG_restrict_type:
4652 return "DW_TAG_restrict_type";
4653 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
4654 return "DW_TAG_interface_type";
4655 case DW_TAG_namespace:
4656 return "DW_TAG_namespace";
4657 case DW_TAG_imported_module:
4658 return "DW_TAG_imported_module";
4659 case DW_TAG_unspecified_type:
4660 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_type";
4661 case DW_TAG_partial_unit:
4662 return "DW_TAG_partial_unit";
4663 case DW_TAG_imported_unit:
4664 return "DW_TAG_imported_unit";
4665 case DW_TAG_condition:
4666 return "DW_TAG_condition";
4667 case DW_TAG_shared_type:
4668 return "DW_TAG_shared_type";
4669 case DW_TAG_MIPS_loop:
4670 return "DW_TAG_MIPS_loop";
4671 case DW_TAG_format_label:
4672 return "DW_TAG_format_label";
4673 case DW_TAG_function_template:
4674 return "DW_TAG_function_template";
4675 case DW_TAG_class_template:
4676 return "DW_TAG_class_template";
4677 case DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL:
4678 return "DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL";
4679 case DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL:
4680 return "DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL";
4681 default:
4682 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
4683 }
4684 }
4685
4686 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
4687
4688 static const char *
4689 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
4690 {
4691 switch (attr)
4692 {
4693 case DW_AT_sibling:
4694 return "DW_AT_sibling";
4695 case DW_AT_location:
4696 return "DW_AT_location";
4697 case DW_AT_name:
4698 return "DW_AT_name";
4699 case DW_AT_ordering:
4700 return "DW_AT_ordering";
4701 case DW_AT_subscr_data:
4702 return "DW_AT_subscr_data";
4703 case DW_AT_byte_size:
4704 return "DW_AT_byte_size";
4705 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
4706 return "DW_AT_bit_offset";
4707 case DW_AT_bit_size:
4708 return "DW_AT_bit_size";
4709 case DW_AT_element_list:
4710 return "DW_AT_element_list";
4711 case DW_AT_stmt_list:
4712 return "DW_AT_stmt_list";
4713 case DW_AT_low_pc:
4714 return "DW_AT_low_pc";
4715 case DW_AT_high_pc:
4716 return "DW_AT_high_pc";
4717 case DW_AT_language:
4718 return "DW_AT_language";
4719 case DW_AT_member:
4720 return "DW_AT_member";
4721 case DW_AT_discr:
4722 return "DW_AT_discr";
4723 case DW_AT_discr_value:
4724 return "DW_AT_discr_value";
4725 case DW_AT_visibility:
4726 return "DW_AT_visibility";
4727 case DW_AT_import:
4728 return "DW_AT_import";
4729 case DW_AT_string_length:
4730 return "DW_AT_string_length";
4731 case DW_AT_common_reference:
4732 return "DW_AT_common_reference";
4733 case DW_AT_comp_dir:
4734 return "DW_AT_comp_dir";
4735 case DW_AT_const_value:
4736 return "DW_AT_const_value";
4737 case DW_AT_containing_type:
4738 return "DW_AT_containing_type";
4739 case DW_AT_default_value:
4740 return "DW_AT_default_value";
4741 case DW_AT_inline:
4742 return "DW_AT_inline";
4743 case DW_AT_is_optional:
4744 return "DW_AT_is_optional";
4745 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
4746 return "DW_AT_lower_bound";
4747 case DW_AT_producer:
4748 return "DW_AT_producer";
4749 case DW_AT_prototyped:
4750 return "DW_AT_prototyped";
4751 case DW_AT_return_addr:
4752 return "DW_AT_return_addr";
4753 case DW_AT_start_scope:
4754 return "DW_AT_start_scope";
4755 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
4756 return "DW_AT_bit_stride";
4757 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
4758 return "DW_AT_upper_bound";
4759 case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
4760 return "DW_AT_abstract_origin";
4761 case DW_AT_accessibility:
4762 return "DW_AT_accessibility";
4763 case DW_AT_address_class:
4764 return "DW_AT_address_class";
4765 case DW_AT_artificial:
4766 return "DW_AT_artificial";
4767 case DW_AT_base_types:
4768 return "DW_AT_base_types";
4769 case DW_AT_calling_convention:
4770 return "DW_AT_calling_convention";
4771 case DW_AT_count:
4772 return "DW_AT_count";
4773 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
4774 return "DW_AT_data_member_location";
4775 case DW_AT_decl_column:
4776 return "DW_AT_decl_column";
4777 case DW_AT_decl_file:
4778 return "DW_AT_decl_file";
4779 case DW_AT_decl_line:
4780 return "DW_AT_decl_line";
4781 case DW_AT_declaration:
4782 return "DW_AT_declaration";
4783 case DW_AT_discr_list:
4784 return "DW_AT_discr_list";
4785 case DW_AT_encoding:
4786 return "DW_AT_encoding";
4787 case DW_AT_external:
4788 return "DW_AT_external";
4789 case DW_AT_frame_base:
4790 return "DW_AT_frame_base";
4791 case DW_AT_friend:
4792 return "DW_AT_friend";
4793 case DW_AT_identifier_case:
4794 return "DW_AT_identifier_case";
4795 case DW_AT_macro_info:
4796 return "DW_AT_macro_info";
4797 case DW_AT_namelist_items:
4798 return "DW_AT_namelist_items";
4799 case DW_AT_priority:
4800 return "DW_AT_priority";
4801 case DW_AT_segment:
4802 return "DW_AT_segment";
4803 case DW_AT_specification:
4804 return "DW_AT_specification";
4805 case DW_AT_static_link:
4806 return "DW_AT_static_link";
4807 case DW_AT_type:
4808 return "DW_AT_type";
4809 case DW_AT_use_location:
4810 return "DW_AT_use_location";
4811 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
4812 return "DW_AT_variable_parameter";
4813 case DW_AT_virtuality:
4814 return "DW_AT_virtuality";
4815 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
4816 return "DW_AT_vtable_elem_location";
4817
4818 case DW_AT_allocated:
4819 return "DW_AT_allocated";
4820 case DW_AT_associated:
4821 return "DW_AT_associated";
4822 case DW_AT_data_location:
4823 return "DW_AT_data_location";
4824 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
4825 return "DW_AT_byte_stride";
4826 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
4827 return "DW_AT_entry_pc";
4828 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
4829 return "DW_AT_use_UTF8";
4830 case DW_AT_extension:
4831 return "DW_AT_extension";
4832 case DW_AT_ranges:
4833 return "DW_AT_ranges";
4834 case DW_AT_trampoline:
4835 return "DW_AT_trampoline";
4836 case DW_AT_call_column:
4837 return "DW_AT_call_column";
4838 case DW_AT_call_file:
4839 return "DW_AT_call_file";
4840 case DW_AT_call_line:
4841 return "DW_AT_call_line";
4842
4843 case DW_AT_MIPS_fde:
4844 return "DW_AT_MIPS_fde";
4845 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin:
4846 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin";
4847 case DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin:
4848 return "DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin";
4849 case DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin:
4850 return "DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin";
4851 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
4852 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
4853 case DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth:
4854 return "DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth";
4855 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
4856 return "DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name";
4857 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
4858 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
4859 case DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name:
4860 return "DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name";
4861 case DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin:
4862 return "DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin";
4863 case DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines:
4864 return "DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines";
4865
4866 case DW_AT_sf_names:
4867 return "DW_AT_sf_names";
4868 case DW_AT_src_info:
4869 return "DW_AT_src_info";
4870 case DW_AT_mac_info:
4871 return "DW_AT_mac_info";
4872 case DW_AT_src_coords:
4873 return "DW_AT_src_coords";
4874 case DW_AT_body_begin:
4875 return "DW_AT_body_begin";
4876 case DW_AT_body_end:
4877 return "DW_AT_body_end";
4878 case DW_AT_GNU_vector:
4879 return "DW_AT_GNU_vector";
4880
4881 case DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address:
4882 return "DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address";
4883
4884 default:
4885 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
4886 }
4887 }
4888
4889 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
4890
4891 static const char *
4892 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
4893 {
4894 switch (form)
4895 {
4896 case DW_FORM_addr:
4897 return "DW_FORM_addr";
4898 case DW_FORM_block2:
4899 return "DW_FORM_block2";
4900 case DW_FORM_block4:
4901 return "DW_FORM_block4";
4902 case DW_FORM_data2:
4903 return "DW_FORM_data2";
4904 case DW_FORM_data4:
4905 return "DW_FORM_data4";
4906 case DW_FORM_data8:
4907 return "DW_FORM_data8";
4908 case DW_FORM_string:
4909 return "DW_FORM_string";
4910 case DW_FORM_block:
4911 return "DW_FORM_block";
4912 case DW_FORM_block1:
4913 return "DW_FORM_block1";
4914 case DW_FORM_data1:
4915 return "DW_FORM_data1";
4916 case DW_FORM_flag:
4917 return "DW_FORM_flag";
4918 case DW_FORM_sdata:
4919 return "DW_FORM_sdata";
4920 case DW_FORM_strp:
4921 return "DW_FORM_strp";
4922 case DW_FORM_udata:
4923 return "DW_FORM_udata";
4924 case DW_FORM_ref_addr:
4925 return "DW_FORM_ref_addr";
4926 case DW_FORM_ref1:
4927 return "DW_FORM_ref1";
4928 case DW_FORM_ref2:
4929 return "DW_FORM_ref2";
4930 case DW_FORM_ref4:
4931 return "DW_FORM_ref4";
4932 case DW_FORM_ref8:
4933 return "DW_FORM_ref8";
4934 case DW_FORM_ref_udata:
4935 return "DW_FORM_ref_udata";
4936 case DW_FORM_indirect:
4937 return "DW_FORM_indirect";
4938 default:
4939 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
4940 }
4941 }
4942 \f
4943 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
4944 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
4945 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4946 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4947 given block. */
4948
4949 static tree
4950 decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree decl)
4951 {
4952 if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
4953 return NULL_TREE;
4954
4955 /* output_inline_function sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4956 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4957 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4958 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
4959 return NULL_TREE;
4960
4961 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
4962 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
4963 gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
4964
4965 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
4966 }
4967
4968 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a block. The block may be an inlined
4969 instance of an inlined instance of a block which is local to an inline
4970 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4971 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4972 given block. */
4973
4974 static tree
4975 block_ultimate_origin (const_tree block)
4976 {
4977 tree immediate_origin = BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (block);
4978
4979 /* output_inline_function sets BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4980 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4981 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4982 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT (block) && immediate_origin == block)
4983 return NULL_TREE;
4984
4985 if (immediate_origin == NULL_TREE)
4986 return NULL_TREE;
4987 else
4988 {
4989 tree ret_val;
4990 tree lookahead = immediate_origin;
4991
4992 do
4993 {
4994 ret_val = lookahead;
4995 lookahead = (TREE_CODE (ret_val) == BLOCK
4996 ? BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (ret_val) : NULL);
4997 }
4998 while (lookahead != NULL && lookahead != ret_val);
4999
5000 /* The block's abstract origin chain may not be the *ultimate* origin of
5001 the block. It could lead to a DECL that has an abstract origin set.
5002 If so, we want that DECL's abstract origin (which is what DECL_ORIGIN
5003 will give us if it has one). Note that DECL's abstract origins are
5004 supposed to be the most distant ancestor (or so decl_ultimate_origin
5005 claims), so we don't need to loop following the DECL origins. */
5006 if (DECL_P (ret_val))
5007 return DECL_ORIGIN (ret_val);
5008
5009 return ret_val;
5010 }
5011 }
5012
5013 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
5014 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
5015 parameter. */
5016
5017 static tree
5018 decl_class_context (tree decl)
5019 {
5020 tree context = NULL_TREE;
5021
5022 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
5023 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
5024 else
5025 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
5026 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
5027
5028 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
5029 context = NULL_TREE;
5030
5031 return context;
5032 }
5033 \f
5034 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. */
5035
5036 static inline void
5037 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_ref attr)
5038 {
5039 /* Maybe this should be an assert? */
5040 if (die == NULL)
5041 return;
5042
5043 if (die->die_attr == NULL)
5044 die->die_attr = VEC_alloc (dw_attr_node, gc, 1);
5045 VEC_safe_push (dw_attr_node, gc, die->die_attr, attr);
5046 }
5047
5048 static inline enum dw_val_class
5049 AT_class (dw_attr_ref a)
5050 {
5051 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
5052 }
5053
5054 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
5055
5056 static inline void
5057 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
5058 {
5059 dw_attr_node attr;
5060
5061 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5062 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
5063 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
5064 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5065 }
5066
5067 static inline unsigned
5068 AT_flag (dw_attr_ref a)
5069 {
5070 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
5071 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
5072 }
5073
5074 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
5075
5076 static inline void
5077 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
5078 {
5079 dw_attr_node attr;
5080
5081 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5082 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
5083 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
5084 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5085 }
5086
5087 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
5088 AT_int (dw_attr_ref a)
5089 {
5090 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const);
5091 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
5092 }
5093
5094 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
5095
5096 static inline void
5097 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5098 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
5099 {
5100 dw_attr_node attr;
5101
5102 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5103 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
5104 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
5105 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5106 }
5107
5108 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
5109 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref a)
5110 {
5111 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const);
5112 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
5113 }
5114
5115 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
5116
5117 static inline void
5118 add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5119 long unsigned int val_hi, long unsigned int val_low)
5120 {
5121 dw_attr_node attr;
5122
5123 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5124 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_long_long;
5125 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi = val_hi;
5126 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low = val_low;
5127 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5128 }
5129
5130 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
5131
5132 static inline void
5133 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5134 unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
5135 {
5136 dw_attr_node attr;
5137
5138 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5139 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
5140 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
5141 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
5142 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
5143 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5144 }
5145
5146 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash. */
5147
5148 static hashval_t
5149 debug_str_do_hash (const void *x)
5150 {
5151 return htab_hash_string (((const struct indirect_string_node *)x)->str);
5152 }
5153
5154 static int
5155 debug_str_eq (const void *x1, const void *x2)
5156 {
5157 return strcmp ((((const struct indirect_string_node *)x1)->str),
5158 (const char *)x2) == 0;
5159 }
5160
5161 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
5162
5163 static inline void
5164 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
5165 {
5166 dw_attr_node attr;
5167 struct indirect_string_node *node;
5168 void **slot;
5169
5170 if (! debug_str_hash)
5171 debug_str_hash = htab_create_ggc (10, debug_str_do_hash,
5172 debug_str_eq, NULL);
5173
5174 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, str,
5175 htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
5176 if (*slot == NULL)
5177 {
5178 node = (struct indirect_string_node *)
5179 ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct indirect_string_node));
5180 node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
5181 *slot = node;
5182 }
5183 else
5184 node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *slot;
5185
5186 node->refcount++;
5187
5188 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5189 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
5190 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
5191 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5192 }
5193
5194 static inline const char *
5195 AT_string (dw_attr_ref a)
5196 {
5197 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
5198 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
5199 }
5200
5201 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
5202 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
5203
5204 static int
5205 AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref a)
5206 {
5207 struct indirect_string_node *node;
5208 unsigned int len;
5209 char label[32];
5210
5211 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
5212
5213 node = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
5214 if (node->form)
5215 return node->form;
5216
5217 len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
5218
5219 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
5220 always better to put it inline. */
5221 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
5222 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
5223
5224 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
5225 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
5226 single module. */
5227 if ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
5228 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len)
5229 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
5230
5231 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
5232 ++dw2_string_counter;
5233 node->label = xstrdup (label);
5234
5235 return node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
5236 }
5237
5238 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
5239
5240 static inline void
5241 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
5242 {
5243 dw_attr_node attr;
5244
5245 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5246 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
5247 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
5248 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
5249 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5250 }
5251
5252 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
5253 pointer from the specification to the definition. */
5254
5255 static inline void
5256 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
5257 {
5258 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
5259 gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
5260 targ_die->die_definition = die;
5261 }
5262
5263 static inline dw_die_ref
5264 AT_ref (dw_attr_ref a)
5265 {
5266 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
5267 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
5268 }
5269
5270 static inline int
5271 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a)
5272 {
5273 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
5274 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
5275
5276 return 0;
5277 }
5278
5279 static inline void
5280 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a, int i)
5281 {
5282 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
5283 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
5284 }
5285
5286 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
5287
5288 static inline void
5289 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
5290 {
5291 dw_attr_node attr;
5292
5293 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5294 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
5295 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
5296 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5297 }
5298
5299 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
5300
5301 static inline void
5302 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5303 {
5304 dw_attr_node attr;
5305
5306 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5307 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
5308 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
5309 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5310 }
5311
5312 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
5313 AT_loc (dw_attr_ref a)
5314 {
5315 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
5316 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
5317 }
5318
5319 static inline void
5320 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
5321 {
5322 dw_attr_node attr;
5323
5324 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5325 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
5326 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
5327 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5328 have_location_lists = true;
5329 }
5330
5331 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
5332 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref a)
5333 {
5334 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
5335 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
5336 }
5337
5338 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. */
5339
5340 static inline void
5341 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr)
5342 {
5343 dw_attr_node attr;
5344
5345 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5346 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
5347 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
5348 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5349 }
5350
5351 /* Get the RTX from to an address DIE attribute. */
5352
5353 static inline rtx
5354 AT_addr (dw_attr_ref a)
5355 {
5356 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
5357 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
5358 }
5359
5360 /* Add a file attribute value to a DIE. */
5361
5362 static inline void
5363 add_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5364 struct dwarf_file_data *fd)
5365 {
5366 dw_attr_node attr;
5367
5368 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5369 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_file;
5370 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_file = fd;
5371 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5372 }
5373
5374 /* Get the dwarf_file_data from a file DIE attribute. */
5375
5376 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
5377 AT_file (dw_attr_ref a)
5378 {
5379 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file);
5380 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file;
5381 }
5382
5383 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
5384
5385 static inline void
5386 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *lbl_id)
5387 {
5388 dw_attr_node attr;
5389
5390 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5391 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
5392 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
5393 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5394 }
5395
5396 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5397 debug_line section. */
5398
5399 static inline void
5400 add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5401 const char *label)
5402 {
5403 dw_attr_node attr;
5404
5405 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5406 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lineptr;
5407 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5408 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5409 }
5410
5411 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5412 debug_macinfo section. */
5413
5414 static inline void
5415 add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5416 const char *label)
5417 {
5418 dw_attr_node attr;
5419
5420 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5421 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_macptr;
5422 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5423 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5424 }
5425
5426 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
5427
5428 static inline void
5429 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5430 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5431 {
5432 dw_attr_node attr;
5433
5434 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5435 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
5436 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5437 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5438 }
5439
5440 /* Add an range_list attribute value to a DIE. */
5441
5442 static void
5443 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5444 long unsigned int offset)
5445 {
5446 dw_attr_node attr;
5447
5448 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5449 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
5450 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5451 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5452 }
5453
5454 static inline const char *
5455 AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref a)
5456 {
5457 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
5458 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lineptr
5459 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_macptr));
5460 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
5461 }
5462
5463 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
5464
5465 static dw_attr_ref
5466 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5467 {
5468 dw_attr_ref a;
5469 unsigned ix;
5470 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
5471
5472 if (! die)
5473 return NULL;
5474
5475 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
5476 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5477 return a;
5478 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
5479 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
5480 spec = AT_ref (a);
5481
5482 if (spec)
5483 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
5484
5485 return NULL;
5486 }
5487
5488 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5489 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5490 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5491
5492 static inline const char *
5493 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5494 {
5495 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
5496
5497 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5498 }
5499
5500 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5501 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5502 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5503
5504 static inline const char *
5505 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5506 {
5507 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
5508
5509 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5510 }
5511
5512 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
5513 NULL if it is not present. */
5514
5515 static inline const char *
5516 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5517 {
5518 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5519
5520 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
5521 }
5522
5523 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
5524 if it is not present. */
5525
5526 static inline int
5527 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5528 {
5529 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5530
5531 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
5532 }
5533
5534 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
5535 if it is not present. */
5536
5537 static inline unsigned
5538 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5539 {
5540 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5541
5542 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
5543 }
5544
5545 static inline dw_die_ref
5546 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5547 {
5548 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5549
5550 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
5551 }
5552
5553 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
5554 get_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5555 {
5556 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5557
5558 return a ? AT_file (a) : NULL;
5559 }
5560
5561 /* Return TRUE if the language is C or C++. */
5562
5563 static inline bool
5564 is_c_family (void)
5565 {
5566 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5567
5568 return (lang == DW_LANG_C || lang == DW_LANG_C89 || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC
5569 || lang == DW_LANG_C99
5570 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus);
5571 }
5572
5573 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++. */
5574
5575 static inline bool
5576 is_cxx (void)
5577 {
5578 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5579
5580 return lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
5581 }
5582
5583 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran. */
5584
5585 static inline bool
5586 is_fortran (void)
5587 {
5588 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5589
5590 return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
5591 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
5592 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95);
5593 }
5594
5595 /* Return TRUE if the language is Java. */
5596
5597 static inline bool
5598 is_java (void)
5599 {
5600 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5601
5602 return lang == DW_LANG_Java;
5603 }
5604
5605 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada. */
5606
5607 static inline bool
5608 is_ada (void)
5609 {
5610 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5611
5612 return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
5613 }
5614
5615 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. */
5616
5617 static void
5618 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5619 {
5620 dw_attr_ref a;
5621 unsigned ix;
5622
5623 if (! die)
5624 return;
5625
5626 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
5627 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5628 {
5629 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
5630 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
5631 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
5632
5633 /* VEC_ordered_remove should help reduce the number of abbrevs
5634 that are needed. */
5635 VEC_ordered_remove (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix);
5636 return;
5637 }
5638 }
5639
5640 /* Remove CHILD from its parent. PREV must have the property that
5641 PREV->DIE_SIB == CHILD. Does not alter CHILD. */
5642
5643 static void
5644 remove_child_with_prev (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
5645 {
5646 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == prev->die_parent);
5647 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == child);
5648 if (prev == child)
5649 {
5650 gcc_assert (child->die_parent->die_child == child);
5651 prev = NULL;
5652 }
5653 else
5654 prev->die_sib = child->die_sib;
5655 if (child->die_parent->die_child == child)
5656 child->die_parent->die_child = prev;
5657 }
5658
5659 /* Remove child DIE whose die_tag is TAG. Do nothing if no child
5660 matches TAG. */
5661
5662 static void
5663 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
5664 {
5665 dw_die_ref c;
5666
5667 c = die->die_child;
5668 if (c) do {
5669 dw_die_ref prev = c;
5670 c = c->die_sib;
5671 while (c->die_tag == tag)
5672 {
5673 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
5674 /* Might have removed every child. */
5675 if (c == c->die_sib)
5676 return;
5677 c = c->die_sib;
5678 }
5679 } while (c != die->die_child);
5680 }
5681
5682 /* Add a CHILD_DIE as the last child of DIE. */
5683
5684 static void
5685 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
5686 {
5687 /* FIXME this should probably be an assert. */
5688 if (! die || ! child_die)
5689 return;
5690 gcc_assert (die != child_die);
5691
5692 child_die->die_parent = die;
5693 if (die->die_child)
5694 {
5695 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child->die_sib;
5696 die->die_child->die_sib = child_die;
5697 }
5698 else
5699 child_die->die_sib = child_die;
5700 die->die_child = child_die;
5701 }
5702
5703 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
5704 is the specification, to the end of PARENT's list of children.
5705 This is done by removing and re-adding it. */
5706
5707 static void
5708 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
5709 {
5710 dw_die_ref p;
5711
5712 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
5713 specification DIE at toplevel. */
5714 if (child->die_parent != parent)
5715 {
5716 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
5717
5718 if (tmp)
5719 child = tmp;
5720 }
5721
5722 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
5723 || (child->die_parent
5724 == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
5725
5726 for (p = child->die_parent->die_child; ; p = p->die_sib)
5727 if (p->die_sib == child)
5728 {
5729 remove_child_with_prev (child, p);
5730 break;
5731 }
5732
5733 add_child_die (parent, child);
5734 }
5735
5736 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node. */
5737
5738 static inline dw_die_ref
5739 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
5740 {
5741 dw_die_ref die = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (die_node));
5742
5743 die->die_tag = tag_value;
5744
5745 if (parent_die != NULL)
5746 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
5747 else
5748 {
5749 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
5750
5751 limbo_node = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (limbo_die_node));
5752 limbo_node->die = die;
5753 limbo_node->created_for = t;
5754 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
5755 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
5756 }
5757
5758 return die;
5759 }
5760
5761 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
5762
5763 static inline dw_die_ref
5764 lookup_type_die (tree type)
5765 {
5766 return TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
5767 }
5768
5769 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
5770
5771 static inline void
5772 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5773 {
5774 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
5775 }
5776
5777 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
5778
5779 static hashval_t
5780 decl_die_table_hash (const void *x)
5781 {
5782 return (hashval_t) ((const_dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id;
5783 }
5784
5785 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y. */
5786
5787 static int
5788 decl_die_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
5789 {
5790 return (((const_dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const_tree) y));
5791 }
5792
5793 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
5794
5795 static inline dw_die_ref
5796 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
5797 {
5798 return htab_find_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5799 }
5800
5801 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list). */
5802
5803 static hashval_t
5804 decl_loc_table_hash (const void *x)
5805 {
5806 return (hashval_t) ((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id;
5807 }
5808
5809 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
5810 UID of decl *Y. */
5811
5812 static int
5813 decl_loc_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
5814 {
5815 return (((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const_tree) y));
5816 }
5817
5818 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration. */
5819
5820 static inline var_loc_list *
5821 lookup_decl_loc (const_tree decl)
5822 {
5823 return htab_find_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5824 }
5825
5826 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
5827
5828 static void
5829 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
5830 {
5831 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5832 void **slot;
5833
5834 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5835 *slot = decl_die;
5836 decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
5837 }
5838
5839 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL. */
5840
5841 static void
5842 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, struct var_loc_node *loc)
5843 {
5844 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5845 var_loc_list *temp;
5846 void **slot;
5847
5848 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5849 if (*slot == NULL)
5850 {
5851 temp = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (var_loc_list));
5852 temp->decl_id = decl_id;
5853 *slot = temp;
5854 }
5855 else
5856 temp = *slot;
5857
5858 if (temp->last)
5859 {
5860 /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
5861 and either both or neither of the locations is uninitialized,
5862 we have nothing to do. */
5863 if ((!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->last->var_loc_note),
5864 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note)))
5865 || ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (temp->last->var_loc_note)
5866 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc->var_loc_note))
5867 && ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (temp->last->var_loc_note)
5868 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
5869 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc->var_loc_note)
5870 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED))))
5871 {
5872 /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST. */
5873 temp->last->next = loc;
5874 temp->last = loc;
5875 }
5876 }
5877 /* Do not add empty location to the beginning of the list. */
5878 else if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
5879 {
5880 temp->first = loc;
5881 temp->last = loc;
5882 }
5883 }
5884 \f
5885 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
5886 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
5887 the DIE internal representation. */
5888 static int print_indent;
5889
5890 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
5891
5892 static inline void
5893 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
5894 {
5895 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
5896 }
5897
5898 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
5899 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5900
5901 static void
5902 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
5903 {
5904 dw_attr_ref a;
5905 dw_die_ref c;
5906 unsigned ix;
5907
5908 print_spaces (outfile);
5909 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4ld: %s\n",
5910 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
5911 print_spaces (outfile);
5912 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
5913 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %ld\n", die->die_offset);
5914
5915 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
5916 {
5917 print_spaces (outfile);
5918 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
5919
5920 switch (AT_class (a))
5921 {
5922 case dw_val_class_addr:
5923 fprintf (outfile, "address");
5924 break;
5925 case dw_val_class_offset:
5926 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
5927 break;
5928 case dw_val_class_loc:
5929 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
5930 break;
5931 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
5932 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
5933 AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol);
5934 break;
5935 case dw_val_class_range_list:
5936 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
5937 break;
5938 case dw_val_class_const:
5939 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, AT_int (a));
5940 break;
5941 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5942 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, AT_unsigned (a));
5943 break;
5944 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5945 fprintf (outfile, "constant (%lu,%lu)",
5946 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi,
5947 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low);
5948 break;
5949 case dw_val_class_vec:
5950 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
5951 break;
5952 case dw_val_class_flag:
5953 fprintf (outfile, "%u", AT_flag (a));
5954 break;
5955 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5956 if (AT_ref (a) != NULL)
5957 {
5958 if (AT_ref (a)->die_symbol)
5959 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s", AT_ref (a)->die_symbol);
5960 else
5961 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %ld", AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
5962 }
5963 else
5964 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
5965 break;
5966 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5967 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5968 case dw_val_class_macptr:
5969 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", AT_lbl (a));
5970 break;
5971 case dw_val_class_str:
5972 if (AT_string (a) != NULL)
5973 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", AT_string (a));
5974 else
5975 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
5976 break;
5977 case dw_val_class_file:
5978 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\" (%d)", AT_file (a)->filename,
5979 AT_file (a)->emitted_number);
5980 break;
5981 default:
5982 break;
5983 }
5984
5985 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5986 }
5987
5988 if (die->die_child != NULL)
5989 {
5990 print_indent += 4;
5991 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, print_die (c, outfile));
5992 print_indent -= 4;
5993 }
5994 if (print_indent == 0)
5995 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5996 }
5997
5998 /* Print the contents of the source code line number correspondence table.
5999 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
6000
6001 static void
6002 print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *outfile)
6003 {
6004 unsigned i;
6005 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
6006
6007 fprintf (outfile, "\n\nDWARF source line information\n");
6008 for (i = 1; i < line_info_table_in_use; i++)
6009 {
6010 line_info = &line_info_table[i];
6011 fprintf (outfile, "%5d: %4ld %6ld\n", i,
6012 line_info->dw_file_num,
6013 line_info->dw_line_num);
6014 }
6015
6016 fprintf (outfile, "\n\n");
6017 }
6018
6019 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
6020
6021 void
6022 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
6023 {
6024 print_die (die, stderr);
6025 }
6026
6027 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
6028 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
6029
6030 void
6031 debug_dwarf (void)
6032 {
6033 print_indent = 0;
6034 print_die (comp_unit_die, stderr);
6035 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
6036 print_dwarf_line_table (stderr);
6037 }
6038 \f
6039 /* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file. OLD_UNIT is the CU
6040 for the enclosing include file, if any. BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
6041 DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file. */
6042
6043 static dw_die_ref
6044 push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit, dw_die_ref bincl_die)
6045 {
6046 const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
6047 dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
6048
6049 new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
6050 return new_unit;
6051 }
6052
6053 /* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one. */
6054
6055 static dw_die_ref
6056 pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit)
6057 {
6058 dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
6059
6060 old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
6061 return new_unit;
6062 }
6063
6064 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
6065 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
6066
6067 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
6068
6069 static inline void
6070 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6071 {
6072 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_opc);
6073 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
6074 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
6075 }
6076
6077 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
6078
6079 static void
6080 attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6081 {
6082 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
6083 rtx r;
6084
6085 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
6086
6087 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
6088 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
6089 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
6090 return;
6091
6092 switch (AT_class (at))
6093 {
6094 case dw_val_class_const:
6095 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
6096 break;
6097 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6098 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
6099 break;
6100 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6101 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long);
6102 break;
6103 case dw_val_class_vec:
6104 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec);
6105 break;
6106 case dw_val_class_flag:
6107 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
6108 break;
6109 case dw_val_class_str:
6110 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
6111 break;
6112
6113 case dw_val_class_addr:
6114 r = AT_addr (at);
6115 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
6116 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
6117 break;
6118
6119 case dw_val_class_offset:
6120 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
6121 break;
6122
6123 case dw_val_class_loc:
6124 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
6125 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
6126 break;
6127
6128 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6129 die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
6130 break;
6131
6132 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6133 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6134 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6135 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6136 break;
6137
6138 case dw_val_class_file:
6139 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
6140 break;
6141
6142 default:
6143 break;
6144 }
6145 }
6146
6147 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
6148
6149 static void
6150 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6151 {
6152 dw_die_ref c;
6153 dw_attr_ref a;
6154 unsigned ix;
6155
6156 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
6157 if (die->die_mark)
6158 {
6159 CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
6160 return;
6161 }
6162 die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6163
6164 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
6165
6166 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6167 attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
6168
6169 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, die_checksum (c, ctx, mark));
6170 }
6171
6172 #undef CHECKSUM
6173 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
6174
6175 /* Do the location expressions look same? */
6176 static inline int
6177 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
6178 {
6179 return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
6180 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
6181 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
6182 }
6183
6184 /* Do the values look the same? */
6185 static int
6186 same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *v1, const dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
6187 {
6188 dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
6189 rtx r1, r2;
6190
6191 if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
6192 return 0;
6193
6194 switch (v1->val_class)
6195 {
6196 case dw_val_class_const:
6197 return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
6198 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6199 return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
6200 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6201 return v1->v.val_long_long.hi == v2->v.val_long_long.hi
6202 && v1->v.val_long_long.low == v2->v.val_long_long.low;
6203 case dw_val_class_vec:
6204 if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
6205 || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
6206 return 0;
6207 if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
6208 v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
6209 return 0;
6210 return 1;
6211 case dw_val_class_flag:
6212 return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
6213 case dw_val_class_str:
6214 return !strcmp(v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
6215
6216 case dw_val_class_addr:
6217 r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
6218 r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
6219 if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
6220 return 0;
6221 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r1) == SYMBOL_REF);
6222 return !strcmp (XSTR (r1, 0), XSTR (r2, 0));
6223
6224 case dw_val_class_offset:
6225 return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
6226
6227 case dw_val_class_loc:
6228 for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
6229 loc1 && loc2;
6230 loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
6231 if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
6232 return 0;
6233 return !loc1 && !loc2;
6234
6235 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6236 return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
6237
6238 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6239 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6240 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6241 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6242 return 1;
6243
6244 case dw_val_class_file:
6245 return v1->v.val_file == v2->v.val_file;
6246
6247 default:
6248 return 1;
6249 }
6250 }
6251
6252 /* Do the attributes look the same? */
6253
6254 static int
6255 same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref at1, dw_attr_ref at2, int *mark)
6256 {
6257 if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
6258 return 0;
6259
6260 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
6261 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
6262 if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
6263 return 1;
6264
6265 return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
6266 }
6267
6268 /* Do the dies look the same? */
6269
6270 static int
6271 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
6272 {
6273 dw_die_ref c1, c2;
6274 dw_attr_ref a1;
6275 unsigned ix;
6276
6277 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
6278 if (die1->die_mark)
6279 return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
6280 die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6281
6282 if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
6283 return 0;
6284
6285 if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr)
6286 != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr))
6287 return 0;
6288
6289 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr, ix, a1); ix++)
6290 if (!same_attr_p (a1, VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr, ix), mark))
6291 return 0;
6292
6293 c1 = die1->die_child;
6294 c2 = die2->die_child;
6295 if (! c1)
6296 {
6297 if (c2)
6298 return 0;
6299 }
6300 else
6301 for (;;)
6302 {
6303 if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
6304 return 0;
6305 c1 = c1->die_sib;
6306 c2 = c2->die_sib;
6307 if (c1 == die1->die_child)
6308 {
6309 if (c2 == die2->die_child)
6310 break;
6311 else
6312 return 0;
6313 }
6314 }
6315
6316 return 1;
6317 }
6318
6319 /* Do the dies look the same? Wrapper around same_die_p. */
6320
6321 static int
6322 same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2)
6323 {
6324 int mark = 0;
6325 int ret = same_die_p (die1, die2, &mark);
6326
6327 unmark_all_dies (die1);
6328 unmark_all_dies (die2);
6329
6330 return ret;
6331 }
6332
6333 /* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
6334 info section. */
6335 static char *comdat_symbol_id;
6336
6337 /* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU. */
6338 static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
6339
6340 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
6341 children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly. */
6342
6343 static void
6344 compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref unit_die)
6345 {
6346 const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
6347 const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
6348 char *name = alloca (strlen (base) + 64);
6349 char *p;
6350 int i, mark;
6351 unsigned char checksum[16];
6352 struct md5_ctx ctx;
6353
6354 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
6355 the name filename of the unit. */
6356
6357 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
6358 mark = 0;
6359 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
6360 unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
6361 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
6362
6363 sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
6364 clean_symbol_name (name);
6365
6366 p = name + strlen (name);
6367 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
6368 {
6369 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
6370 p += 2;
6371 }
6372
6373 comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
6374 comdat_symbol_number = 0;
6375 }
6376
6377 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
6378
6379 static int
6380 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
6381 {
6382 switch (die->die_tag)
6383 {
6384 case DW_TAG_array_type:
6385 case DW_TAG_class_type:
6386 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
6387 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
6388 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
6389 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
6390 case DW_TAG_string_type:
6391 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
6392 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
6393 case DW_TAG_union_type:
6394 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
6395 case DW_TAG_set_type:
6396 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
6397 case DW_TAG_base_type:
6398 case DW_TAG_const_type:
6399 case DW_TAG_file_type:
6400 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
6401 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
6402 case DW_TAG_typedef:
6403 return 1;
6404 default:
6405 return 0;
6406 }
6407 }
6408
6409 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
6410 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
6411 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
6412 compilations (functions). */
6413
6414 static int
6415 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
6416 {
6417 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
6418 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
6419 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
6420 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
6421
6422 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
6423 return 0;
6424
6425 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
6426 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
6427 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
6428 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
6429 {
6430 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
6431
6432 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
6433 }
6434
6435 return is_type_die (c);
6436 }
6437
6438 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
6439 compilation unit. */
6440
6441 static int
6442 is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref c)
6443 {
6444 return (is_type_die (c)
6445 || (get_AT (c, DW_AT_declaration)
6446 && !get_AT (c, DW_AT_specification))
6447 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
6448 }
6449
6450 static char *
6451 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
6452 {
6453 char buf[256];
6454
6455 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
6456 return xstrdup (buf);
6457 }
6458
6459 /* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE. */
6460
6461 static void
6462 assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref die)
6463 {
6464 dw_die_ref c;
6465
6466 if (is_symbol_die (die))
6467 {
6468 if (comdat_symbol_id)
6469 {
6470 char *p = alloca (strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
6471
6472 sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
6473 comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
6474 die->die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
6475 }
6476 else
6477 die->die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
6478 }
6479
6480 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, assign_symbol_names (c));
6481 }
6482
6483 struct cu_hash_table_entry
6484 {
6485 dw_die_ref cu;
6486 unsigned min_comdat_num, max_comdat_num;
6487 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
6488 };
6489
6490 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
6491 static hashval_t
6492 htab_cu_hash (const void *of)
6493 {
6494 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry = of;
6495
6496 return htab_hash_string (entry->cu->die_symbol);
6497 }
6498
6499 static int
6500 htab_cu_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
6501 {
6502 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry1 = of1;
6503 const struct die_struct *entry2 = of2;
6504
6505 return !strcmp (entry1->cu->die_symbol, entry2->die_symbol);
6506 }
6507
6508 static void
6509 htab_cu_del (void *what)
6510 {
6511 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next, *entry = what;
6512
6513 while (entry)
6514 {
6515 next = entry->next;
6516 free (entry);
6517 entry = next;
6518 }
6519 }
6520
6521 /* Check whether we have already seen this CU and set up SYM_NUM
6522 accordingly. */
6523 static int
6524 check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int *sym_num)
6525 {
6526 struct cu_hash_table_entry dummy;
6527 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry, *last = &dummy;
6528
6529 dummy.max_comdat_num = 0;
6530
6531 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
6532 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
6533 INSERT);
6534 entry = *slot;
6535
6536 for (; entry; last = entry, entry = entry->next)
6537 {
6538 if (same_die_p_wrap (cu, entry->cu))
6539 break;
6540 }
6541
6542 if (entry)
6543 {
6544 *sym_num = entry->min_comdat_num;
6545 return 1;
6546 }
6547
6548 entry = XCNEW (struct cu_hash_table_entry);
6549 entry->cu = cu;
6550 entry->min_comdat_num = *sym_num = last->max_comdat_num;
6551 entry->next = *slot;
6552 *slot = entry;
6553
6554 return 0;
6555 }
6556
6557 /* Record SYM_NUM to record of CU in HTABLE. */
6558 static void
6559 record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int sym_num)
6560 {
6561 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry;
6562
6563 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
6564 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
6565 NO_INSERT);
6566 entry = *slot;
6567
6568 entry->max_comdat_num = sym_num;
6569 }
6570
6571 /* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
6572 additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
6573 bracketed by BINCL/EINCL. */
6574
6575 static void
6576 break_out_includes (dw_die_ref die)
6577 {
6578 dw_die_ref c;
6579 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
6580 limbo_die_node *node, **pnode;
6581 htab_t cu_hash_table;
6582
6583 c = die->die_child;
6584 if (c) do {
6585 dw_die_ref prev = c;
6586 c = c->die_sib;
6587 while (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
6588 || (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
6589 {
6590 dw_die_ref next = c->die_sib;
6591
6592 /* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one. */
6593 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
6594
6595 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
6596 unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
6597 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
6598 unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
6599 else
6600 add_child_die (unit, c);
6601 c = next;
6602 if (c == die->die_child)
6603 break;
6604 }
6605 } while (c != die->die_child);
6606
6607 #if 0
6608 /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
6609 to make sure that we leave every include file we enter. */
6610 gcc_assert (!unit);
6611 #endif
6612
6613 assign_symbol_names (die);
6614 cu_hash_table = htab_create (10, htab_cu_hash, htab_cu_eq, htab_cu_del);
6615 for (node = limbo_die_list, pnode = &limbo_die_list;
6616 node;
6617 node = node->next)
6618 {
6619 int is_dupl;
6620
6621 compute_section_prefix (node->die);
6622 is_dupl = check_duplicate_cu (node->die, cu_hash_table,
6623 &comdat_symbol_number);
6624 assign_symbol_names (node->die);
6625 if (is_dupl)
6626 *pnode = node->next;
6627 else
6628 {
6629 pnode = &node->next;
6630 record_comdat_symbol_number (node->die, cu_hash_table,
6631 comdat_symbol_number);
6632 }
6633 }
6634 htab_delete (cu_hash_table);
6635 }
6636
6637 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
6638 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
6639 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
6640
6641 static void
6642 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
6643 {
6644 dw_die_ref c;
6645
6646 if (! die->die_child)
6647 return;
6648
6649 if (die->die_parent && die != die->die_parent->die_child)
6650 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
6651
6652 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_sibling_attributes (c));
6653 }
6654
6655 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
6656
6657 static void
6658 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
6659 {
6660 dw_die_ref c;
6661 dw_attr_ref a;
6662 unsigned ix;
6663
6664 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6665 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
6666 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (a));
6667
6668 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_location_lists (c));
6669 }
6670
6671 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
6672 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
6673 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
6674 die are visited recursively. */
6675
6676 static void
6677 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die)
6678 {
6679 unsigned long abbrev_id;
6680 unsigned int n_alloc;
6681 dw_die_ref c;
6682 dw_attr_ref a;
6683 unsigned ix;
6684
6685 /* Scan the DIE references, and mark as external any that refer to
6686 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
6687 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6688 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
6689 && AT_ref (a)->die_mark == 0)
6690 {
6691 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_symbol);
6692
6693 set_AT_ref_external (a, 1);
6694 }
6695
6696 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6697 {
6698 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6699 dw_attr_ref die_a, abbrev_a;
6700 unsigned ix;
6701 bool ok = true;
6702
6703 if (abbrev->die_tag != die->die_tag)
6704 continue;
6705 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) != (die->die_child != NULL))
6706 continue;
6707
6708 if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr)
6709 != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr))
6710 continue;
6711
6712 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, die_a); ix++)
6713 {
6714 abbrev_a = VEC_index (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix);
6715 if ((abbrev_a->dw_attr != die_a->dw_attr)
6716 || (value_format (abbrev_a) != value_format (die_a)))
6717 {
6718 ok = false;
6719 break;
6720 }
6721 }
6722 if (ok)
6723 break;
6724 }
6725
6726 if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
6727 {
6728 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
6729 {
6730 n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
6731 abbrev_die_table = ggc_realloc (abbrev_die_table,
6732 sizeof (dw_die_ref) * n_alloc);
6733
6734 memset (&abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
6735 (n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
6736 abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
6737 }
6738
6739 ++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
6740 abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
6741 }
6742
6743 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
6744 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, build_abbrev_table (c));
6745 }
6746 \f
6747 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
6748
6749 static int
6750 constant_size (long unsigned int value)
6751 {
6752 int log;
6753
6754 if (value == 0)
6755 log = 0;
6756 else
6757 log = floor_log2 (value);
6758
6759 log = log / 8;
6760 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
6761
6762 return log;
6763 }
6764
6765 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
6766 .debug_info section. */
6767
6768 static unsigned long
6769 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
6770 {
6771 unsigned long size = 0;
6772 dw_attr_ref a;
6773 unsigned ix;
6774
6775 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
6776 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6777 {
6778 switch (AT_class (a))
6779 {
6780 case dw_val_class_addr:
6781 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6782 break;
6783 case dw_val_class_offset:
6784 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6785 break;
6786 case dw_val_class_loc:
6787 {
6788 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
6789
6790 /* Block length. */
6791 size += constant_size (lsize);
6792 size += lsize;
6793 }
6794 break;
6795 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6796 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6797 break;
6798 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6799 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6800 break;
6801 case dw_val_class_const:
6802 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
6803 break;
6804 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6805 size += constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
6806 break;
6807 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6808 size += 1 + 2*HOST_BITS_PER_LONG/HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR; /* block */
6809 break;
6810 case dw_val_class_vec:
6811 size += 1 + (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6812 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size); /* block */
6813 break;
6814 case dw_val_class_flag:
6815 size += 1;
6816 break;
6817 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6818 if (AT_ref_external (a))
6819 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6820 else
6821 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6822 break;
6823 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6824 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6825 break;
6826 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6827 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6828 break;
6829 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6830 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6831 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6832 break;
6833 case dw_val_class_str:
6834 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
6835 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6836 else
6837 size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
6838 break;
6839 case dw_val_class_file:
6840 size += constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file));
6841 break;
6842 default:
6843 gcc_unreachable ();
6844 }
6845 }
6846
6847 return size;
6848 }
6849
6850 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
6851 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
6852 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
6853 die_offset field in each DIE. */
6854
6855 static void
6856 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
6857 {
6858 dw_die_ref c;
6859
6860 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
6861 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
6862
6863 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, calc_die_sizes (c));
6864
6865 if (die->die_child != NULL)
6866 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
6867 next_die_offset += 1;
6868 }
6869
6870 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
6871 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
6872 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
6873 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
6874
6875 static void
6876 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6877 {
6878 dw_die_ref c;
6879
6880 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
6881
6882 die->die_mark = 1;
6883 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_dies (c));
6884 }
6885
6886 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
6887
6888 static void
6889 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6890 {
6891 dw_die_ref c;
6892
6893 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
6894
6895 die->die_mark = 0;
6896 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_dies (c));
6897 }
6898
6899 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
6900
6901 static void
6902 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6903 {
6904 dw_die_ref c;
6905 dw_attr_ref a;
6906 unsigned ix;
6907
6908 if (!die->die_mark)
6909 return;
6910 die->die_mark = 0;
6911
6912 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_all_dies (c));
6913
6914 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6915 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
6916 unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
6917 }
6918
6919 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames or .debug_pubtypes table
6920 generated for the compilation unit. */
6921
6922 static unsigned long
6923 size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * names)
6924 {
6925 unsigned long size;
6926 unsigned i;
6927 pubname_ref p;
6928
6929 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
6930 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, names, i, p); i++)
6931 if (names != pubtype_table
6932 || p->die->die_offset != 0
6933 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
6934 size += strlen (p->name) + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1;
6935
6936 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6937 return size;
6938 }
6939
6940 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
6941
6942 static unsigned long
6943 size_of_aranges (void)
6944 {
6945 unsigned long size;
6946
6947 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
6948
6949 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
6950 if (text_section_used)
6951 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6952 if (cold_text_section_used)
6953 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6954 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * arange_table_in_use;
6955
6956 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
6957 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6958 return size;
6959 }
6960 \f
6961 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
6962
6963 static enum dwarf_form
6964 value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
6965 {
6966 switch (a->dw_attr_val.val_class)
6967 {
6968 case dw_val_class_addr:
6969 return DW_FORM_addr;
6970 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6971 case dw_val_class_offset:
6972 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6973 switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
6974 {
6975 case 4:
6976 return DW_FORM_data4;
6977 case 8:
6978 return DW_FORM_data8;
6979 default:
6980 gcc_unreachable ();
6981 }
6982 case dw_val_class_loc:
6983 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
6984 {
6985 case 1:
6986 return DW_FORM_block1;
6987 case 2:
6988 return DW_FORM_block2;
6989 default:
6990 gcc_unreachable ();
6991 }
6992 case dw_val_class_const:
6993 return DW_FORM_sdata;
6994 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6995 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
6996 {
6997 case 1:
6998 return DW_FORM_data1;
6999 case 2:
7000 return DW_FORM_data2;
7001 case 4:
7002 return DW_FORM_data4;
7003 case 8:
7004 return DW_FORM_data8;
7005 default:
7006 gcc_unreachable ();
7007 }
7008 case dw_val_class_long_long:
7009 return DW_FORM_block1;
7010 case dw_val_class_vec:
7011 return DW_FORM_block1;
7012 case dw_val_class_flag:
7013 return DW_FORM_flag;
7014 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
7015 if (AT_ref_external (a))
7016 return DW_FORM_ref_addr;
7017 else
7018 return DW_FORM_ref;
7019 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
7020 return DW_FORM_data;
7021 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7022 return DW_FORM_addr;
7023 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
7024 case dw_val_class_macptr:
7025 return DW_FORM_data;
7026 case dw_val_class_str:
7027 return AT_string_form (a);
7028 case dw_val_class_file:
7029 switch (constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file)))
7030 {
7031 case 1:
7032 return DW_FORM_data1;
7033 case 2:
7034 return DW_FORM_data2;
7035 case 4:
7036 return DW_FORM_data4;
7037 default:
7038 gcc_unreachable ();
7039 }
7040
7041 default:
7042 gcc_unreachable ();
7043 }
7044 }
7045
7046 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
7047
7048 static void
7049 output_value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
7050 {
7051 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
7052
7053 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
7054 }
7055
7056 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
7057 table. */
7058
7059 static void
7060 output_abbrev_section (void)
7061 {
7062 unsigned long abbrev_id;
7063
7064 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
7065 {
7066 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
7067 unsigned ix;
7068 dw_attr_ref a_attr;
7069
7070 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
7071 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
7072 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
7073
7074 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
7075 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
7076 else
7077 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
7078
7079 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix, a_attr);
7080 ix++)
7081 {
7082 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
7083 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
7084 output_value_format (a_attr);
7085 }
7086
7087 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
7088 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
7089 }
7090
7091 /* Terminate the table. */
7092 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
7093 }
7094
7095 /* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU. */
7096
7097 static inline void
7098 output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref die)
7099 {
7100 char *sym = die->die_symbol;
7101
7102 if (sym == 0)
7103 return;
7104
7105 if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
7106 /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
7107 .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
7108 will break. */
7109 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, sym);
7110
7111 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
7112 }
7113
7114 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
7115 expression. gensym tells us whether to generate a new internal symbol for
7116 this location list node, which is done for the head of the list only. */
7117
7118 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
7119 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
7120 const char *section, unsigned int gensym)
7121 {
7122 dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_list_node));
7123
7124 retlist->begin = begin;
7125 retlist->end = end;
7126 retlist->expr = expr;
7127 retlist->section = section;
7128 if (gensym)
7129 retlist->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
7130
7131 return retlist;
7132 }
7133
7134 /* Add a location description expression to a location list. */
7135
7136 static inline void
7137 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr,
7138 const char *begin, const char *end,
7139 const char *section)
7140 {
7141 dw_loc_list_ref *d;
7142
7143 /* Find the end of the chain. */
7144 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
7145 ;
7146
7147 /* Add a new location list node to the list. */
7148 *d = new_loc_list (descr, begin, end, section, 0);
7149 }
7150
7151 /* Output the location list given to us. */
7152
7153 static void
7154 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
7155 {
7156 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
7157
7158 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
7159
7160 /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression. */
7161 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
7162 {
7163 unsigned long size;
7164 /* Don't output an entry that starts and ends at the same address. */
7165 if (strcmp (curr->begin, curr->end) == 0)
7166 continue;
7167 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
7168 {
7169 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
7170 "Location list begin address (%s)",
7171 list_head->ll_symbol);
7172 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
7173 "Location list end address (%s)",
7174 list_head->ll_symbol);
7175 }
7176 else
7177 {
7178 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
7179 "Location list begin address (%s)",
7180 list_head->ll_symbol);
7181 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
7182 "Location list end address (%s)",
7183 list_head->ll_symbol);
7184 }
7185 size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
7186
7187 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
7188 gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
7189 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
7190
7191 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr);
7192 }
7193
7194 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
7195 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
7196 list_head->ll_symbol);
7197 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
7198 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
7199 list_head->ll_symbol);
7200 }
7201
7202 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
7203 the definitions of each child DIE. */
7204
7205 static void
7206 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
7207 {
7208 dw_attr_ref a;
7209 dw_die_ref c;
7210 unsigned long size;
7211 unsigned ix;
7212
7213 /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
7214 them to point to. */
7215 if (die->die_symbol)
7216 output_die_symbol (die);
7217
7218 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (0x%lx) %s)",
7219 (unsigned long)die->die_offset,
7220 dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
7221
7222 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
7223 {
7224 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
7225
7226 switch (AT_class (a))
7227 {
7228 case dw_val_class_addr:
7229 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
7230 break;
7231
7232 case dw_val_class_offset:
7233 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
7234 "%s", name);
7235 break;
7236
7237 case dw_val_class_range_list:
7238 {
7239 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
7240
7241 sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
7242 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
7243 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
7244 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
7245 *p = '\0';
7246 }
7247 break;
7248
7249 case dw_val_class_loc:
7250 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
7251
7252 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
7253 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
7254
7255 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a));
7256 break;
7257
7258 case dw_val_class_const:
7259 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
7260 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
7261 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
7262 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
7263 break;
7264
7265 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
7266 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)),
7267 AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
7268 break;
7269
7270 case dw_val_class_long_long:
7271 {
7272 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
7273
7274 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
7275 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7276 "%s", name);
7277
7278 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
7279 {
7280 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
7281 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
7282 }
7283 else
7284 {
7285 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
7286 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
7287 }
7288
7289 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7290 first, "long long constant");
7291 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7292 second, NULL);
7293 }
7294 break;
7295
7296 case dw_val_class_vec:
7297 {
7298 unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
7299 unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
7300 unsigned int i;
7301 unsigned char *p;
7302
7303 dw2_asm_output_data (1, len * elt_size, "%s", name);
7304 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
7305 {
7306 elt_size /= 2;
7307 len *= 2;
7308 }
7309 for (i = 0, p = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
7310 i < len;
7311 i++, p += elt_size)
7312 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
7313 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
7314 break;
7315 }
7316
7317 case dw_val_class_flag:
7318 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
7319 break;
7320
7321 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
7322 {
7323 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
7324
7325 gcc_assert (sym);
7326 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
7327 "%s", name);
7328 }
7329 break;
7330
7331 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
7332 if (AT_ref_external (a))
7333 {
7334 char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_symbol;
7335
7336 gcc_assert (sym);
7337 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, sym, debug_info_section,
7338 "%s", name);
7339 }
7340 else
7341 {
7342 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
7343 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
7344 "%s", name);
7345 }
7346 break;
7347
7348 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
7349 {
7350 char l1[20];
7351
7352 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
7353 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
7354 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, debug_frame_section,
7355 "%s", name);
7356 }
7357 break;
7358
7359 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7360 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
7361 break;
7362
7363 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
7364 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
7365 debug_line_section, "%s", name);
7366 break;
7367
7368 case dw_val_class_macptr:
7369 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
7370 debug_macinfo_section, "%s", name);
7371 break;
7372
7373 case dw_val_class_str:
7374 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
7375 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
7376 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
7377 debug_str_section,
7378 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
7379 else
7380 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
7381 break;
7382
7383 case dw_val_class_file:
7384 {
7385 int f = maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
7386
7387 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (f), f, "%s (%s)", name,
7388 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
7389 break;
7390 }
7391
7392 default:
7393 gcc_unreachable ();
7394 }
7395 }
7396
7397 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_die (c));
7398
7399 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
7400 if (die->die_child != NULL)
7401 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE 0x%lx",
7402 (unsigned long) die->die_offset);
7403 }
7404
7405 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
7406 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
7407
7408 static void
7409 output_compilation_unit_header (void)
7410 {
7411 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7412 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7413 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7414 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
7415 next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
7416 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
7417 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF version number");
7418 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
7419 debug_abbrev_section,
7420 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
7421 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
7422 }
7423
7424 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
7425
7426 static void
7427 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty)
7428 {
7429 const char *secname;
7430 char *oldsym, *tmp;
7431
7432 /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
7433 if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
7434 return;
7435
7436 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
7437 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
7438 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
7439 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
7440 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
7441 mark_dies (die);
7442
7443 build_abbrev_table (die);
7444
7445 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
7446 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
7447 calc_die_sizes (die);
7448
7449 oldsym = die->die_symbol;
7450 if (oldsym)
7451 {
7452 tmp = alloca (strlen (oldsym) + 24);
7453
7454 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
7455 secname = tmp;
7456 die->die_symbol = NULL;
7457 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
7458 }
7459 else
7460 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
7461
7462 /* Output debugging information. */
7463 output_compilation_unit_header ();
7464 output_die (die);
7465
7466 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
7467 output_pubnames. */
7468 if (oldsym)
7469 {
7470 unmark_dies (die);
7471 die->die_symbol = oldsym;
7472 }
7473 }
7474
7475 /* Return the DWARF2/3 pubname associated with a decl. */
7476
7477 static const char *
7478 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
7479 {
7480 return lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
7481 }
7482
7483 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
7484
7485 static void
7486 add_pubname_string (const char *str, dw_die_ref die)
7487 {
7488 pubname_entry e;
7489
7490 e.die = die;
7491 e.name = xstrdup (str);
7492 VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubname_table, &e);
7493 }
7494
7495 static void
7496 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7497 {
7498
7499 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
7500 add_pubname_string (dwarf2_name (decl, 1), die);
7501 }
7502
7503 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubtypes if appropriate. */
7504
7505 static void
7506 add_pubtype (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7507 {
7508 pubname_entry e;
7509
7510 e.name = NULL;
7511 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
7512 || die->die_parent == comp_unit_die)
7513 && (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef || COMPLETE_TYPE_P (decl)))
7514 {
7515 e.die = die;
7516 if (TYPE_P (decl))
7517 {
7518 if (TYPE_NAME (decl))
7519 {
7520 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (decl)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
7521 e.name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TYPE_NAME (decl));
7522 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (decl)) == TYPE_DECL
7523 && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (decl)))
7524 e.name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (decl)));
7525 else
7526 e.name = xstrdup ((const char *) get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name));
7527 }
7528 }
7529 else
7530 e.name = xstrdup (dwarf2_name (decl, 1));
7531
7532 /* If we don't have a name for the type, there's no point in adding
7533 it to the table. */
7534 if (e.name && e.name[0] != '\0')
7535 VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubtype_table, &e);
7536 }
7537 }
7538
7539 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
7540 visible names; or the public types table used to find type definitions. */
7541
7542 static void
7543 output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * names)
7544 {
7545 unsigned i;
7546 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames (names);
7547 pubname_ref pub;
7548
7549 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7550 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7551 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7552 if (names == pubname_table)
7553 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
7554 "Length of Public Names Info");
7555 else
7556 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
7557 "Length of Public Type Names Info");
7558 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7559 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
7560 debug_info_section,
7561 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
7562 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
7563 "Compilation Unit Length");
7564
7565 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, names, i, pub); i++)
7566 {
7567 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
7568 if (names == pubname_table)
7569 gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
7570
7571 if (names != pubtype_table
7572 || pub->die->die_offset != 0
7573 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
7574 {
7575 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pub->die->die_offset,
7576 "DIE offset");
7577
7578 dw2_asm_output_nstring (pub->name, -1, "external name");
7579 }
7580 }
7581
7582 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7583 }
7584
7585 /* Add a new entry to .debug_aranges if appropriate. */
7586
7587 static void
7588 add_arange (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7589 {
7590 if (! DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
7591 return;
7592
7593 if (arange_table_in_use == arange_table_allocated)
7594 {
7595 arange_table_allocated += ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7596 arange_table = ggc_realloc (arange_table,
7597 (arange_table_allocated
7598 * sizeof (dw_die_ref)));
7599 memset (arange_table + arange_table_in_use, 0,
7600 ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
7601 }
7602
7603 arange_table[arange_table_in_use++] = die;
7604 }
7605
7606 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
7607 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
7608 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
7609
7610 static void
7611 output_aranges (void)
7612 {
7613 unsigned i;
7614 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
7615
7616 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7617 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7618 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7619 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
7620 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
7621 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7622 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
7623 debug_info_section,
7624 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
7625 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
7626 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
7627
7628 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
7629 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
7630 {
7631 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
7632 pointer size. */
7633 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
7634 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7635 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
7636 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
7637 }
7638
7639 /* It is necessary not to output these entries if the sections were
7640 not used; if the sections were not used, the length will be 0 and
7641 the address may end up as 0 if the section is discarded by ld
7642 --gc-sections, leaving an invalid (0, 0) entry that can be
7643 confused with the terminator. */
7644 if (text_section_used)
7645 {
7646 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
7647 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
7648 text_section_label, "Length");
7649 }
7650 if (cold_text_section_used)
7651 {
7652 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
7653 "Address");
7654 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
7655 cold_text_section_label, "Length");
7656 }
7657
7658 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
7659 {
7660 dw_die_ref die = arange_table[i];
7661
7662 /* We shouldn't see aranges for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
7663 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
7664
7665 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
7666 {
7667 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_low_pc (die),
7668 "Address");
7669 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_hi_pc (die),
7670 get_AT_low_pc (die), "Length");
7671 }
7672 else
7673 {
7674 /* A static variable; extract the symbol from DW_AT_location.
7675 Note that this code isn't currently hit, as we only emit
7676 aranges for functions (jason 9/23/99). */
7677 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
7678 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
7679
7680 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
7681
7682 loc = AT_loc (a);
7683 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr);
7684
7685 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7686 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, "Address");
7687 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7688 get_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size),
7689 "Length");
7690 }
7691 }
7692
7693 /* Output the terminator words. */
7694 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7695 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7696 }
7697
7698 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return the offset at which it
7699 was placed. */
7700
7701 static unsigned int
7702 add_ranges_num (int num)
7703 {
7704 unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
7705
7706 if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
7707 {
7708 ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7709 ranges_table
7710 = ggc_realloc (ranges_table, (ranges_table_allocated
7711 * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct)));
7712 memset (ranges_table + ranges_table_in_use, 0,
7713 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct));
7714 }
7715
7716 ranges_table[in_use].num = num;
7717 ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
7718
7719 return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
7720 }
7721
7722 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a block, or a
7723 range terminator if BLOCK is NULL. */
7724
7725 static unsigned int
7726 add_ranges (const_tree block)
7727 {
7728 return add_ranges_num (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
7729 }
7730
7731 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a pair of
7732 labels. */
7733
7734 static unsigned int
7735 add_ranges_by_labels (const char *begin, const char *end)
7736 {
7737 unsigned int in_use = ranges_by_label_in_use;
7738
7739 if (in_use == ranges_by_label_allocated)
7740 {
7741 ranges_by_label_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7742 ranges_by_label
7743 = ggc_realloc (ranges_by_label,
7744 (ranges_by_label_allocated
7745 * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct)));
7746 memset (ranges_by_label + ranges_by_label_in_use, 0,
7747 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT
7748 * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct));
7749 }
7750
7751 ranges_by_label[in_use].begin = begin;
7752 ranges_by_label[in_use].end = end;
7753 ranges_by_label_in_use = in_use + 1;
7754
7755 return add_ranges_num (-(int)in_use - 1);
7756 }
7757
7758 static void
7759 output_ranges (void)
7760 {
7761 unsigned i;
7762 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset 0x%x";
7763 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
7764
7765 for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
7766 {
7767 int block_num = ranges_table[i].num;
7768
7769 if (block_num > 0)
7770 {
7771 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7772 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7773
7774 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
7775 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
7776
7777 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
7778 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
7779 base of the text section. */
7780 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
7781 {
7782 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
7783 text_section_label,
7784 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7785 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
7786 text_section_label, NULL);
7787 }
7788
7789 /* Otherwise, the compilation unit base address is zero,
7790 which allows us to use absolute addresses, and not worry
7791 about whether the target supports cross-section
7792 arithmetic. */
7793 else
7794 {
7795 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
7796 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7797 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
7798 }
7799
7800 fmt = NULL;
7801 }
7802
7803 /* Negative block_num stands for an index into ranges_by_label. */
7804 else if (block_num < 0)
7805 {
7806 int lab_idx = - block_num - 1;
7807
7808 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
7809 {
7810 gcc_unreachable ();
7811 #if 0
7812 /* If we ever use add_ranges_by_labels () for a single
7813 function section, all we have to do is to take out
7814 the #if 0 above. */
7815 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7816 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].begin,
7817 text_section_label,
7818 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7819 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7820 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].end,
7821 text_section_label, NULL);
7822 #endif
7823 }
7824 else
7825 {
7826 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7827 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].begin,
7828 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7829 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7830 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].end,
7831 NULL);
7832 }
7833 }
7834 else
7835 {
7836 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7837 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7838 fmt = start_fmt;
7839 }
7840 }
7841 }
7842
7843 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
7844 struct file_info
7845 {
7846 const char *path; /* Complete file name. */
7847 const char *fname; /* File name part. */
7848 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
7849 struct dwarf_file_data * file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
7850 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
7851 };
7852
7853 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
7854 files. */
7855 struct dir_info
7856 {
7857 const char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
7858 int length; /* Path length. */
7859 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
7860 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
7861 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
7862 };
7863
7864 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
7865 the directories in the path. */
7866
7867 static int
7868 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
7869 {
7870 const struct file_info *s1 = p1;
7871 const struct file_info *s2 = p2;
7872 const unsigned char *cp1;
7873 const unsigned char *cp2;
7874
7875 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
7876 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
7877 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
7878 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
7879 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
7880 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
7881 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
7882
7883 cp1 = (const unsigned char *) s1->path;
7884 cp2 = (const unsigned char *) s2->path;
7885
7886 while (1)
7887 {
7888 ++cp1;
7889 ++cp2;
7890 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
7891 if ((cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname)
7892 || (cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname))
7893 return ((cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname)
7894 - (cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname));
7895
7896 /* Character of current path component the same? */
7897 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
7898 return *cp1 - *cp2;
7899 }
7900 }
7901
7902 struct file_name_acquire_data
7903 {
7904 struct file_info *files;
7905 int used_files;
7906 int max_files;
7907 };
7908
7909 /* Traversal function for the hash table. */
7910
7911 static int
7912 file_name_acquire (void ** slot, void *data)
7913 {
7914 struct file_name_acquire_data *fnad = data;
7915 struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
7916 struct file_info *fi;
7917 const char *f;
7918
7919 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files >= d->emitted_number);
7920
7921 if (! d->emitted_number)
7922 return 1;
7923
7924 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files != fnad->used_files);
7925
7926 fi = fnad->files + fnad->used_files++;
7927
7928 /* Skip all leading "./". */
7929 f = d->filename;
7930 while (f[0] == '.' && IS_DIR_SEPARATOR (f[1]))
7931 f += 2;
7932
7933 /* Create a new array entry. */
7934 fi->path = f;
7935 fi->length = strlen (f);
7936 fi->file_idx = d;
7937
7938 /* Search for the file name part. */
7939 f = strrchr (f, DIR_SEPARATOR);
7940 #if defined (DIR_SEPARATOR_2)
7941 {
7942 char *g = strrchr (fi->path, DIR_SEPARATOR_2);
7943
7944 if (g != NULL)
7945 {
7946 if (f == NULL || f < g)
7947 f = g;
7948 }
7949 }
7950 #endif
7951
7952 fi->fname = f == NULL ? fi->path : f + 1;
7953 return 1;
7954 }
7955
7956 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
7957 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
7958 slowdowns with many input files. */
7959
7960 static void
7961 output_file_names (void)
7962 {
7963 struct file_name_acquire_data fnad;
7964 int numfiles;
7965 struct file_info *files;
7966 struct dir_info *dirs;
7967 int *saved;
7968 int *savehere;
7969 int *backmap;
7970 int ndirs;
7971 int idx_offset;
7972 int i;
7973 int idx;
7974
7975 if (!last_emitted_file)
7976 {
7977 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
7978 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7979 return;
7980 }
7981
7982 numfiles = last_emitted_file->emitted_number;
7983
7984 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
7985 files = alloca (numfiles * sizeof (struct file_info));
7986 dirs = alloca (numfiles * sizeof (struct dir_info));
7987
7988 fnad.files = files;
7989 fnad.used_files = 0;
7990 fnad.max_files = numfiles;
7991 htab_traverse (file_table, file_name_acquire, &fnad);
7992 gcc_assert (fnad.used_files == fnad.max_files);
7993
7994 qsort (files, numfiles, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
7995
7996 /* Find all the different directories used. */
7997 dirs[0].path = files[0].path;
7998 dirs[0].length = files[0].fname - files[0].path;
7999 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
8000 dirs[0].count = 1;
8001 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
8002 files[0].dir_idx = 0;
8003 ndirs = 1;
8004
8005 for (i = 1; i < numfiles; i++)
8006 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
8007 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
8008 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
8009 {
8010 /* Same directory as last entry. */
8011 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
8012 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
8013 }
8014 else
8015 {
8016 int j;
8017
8018 /* This is a new directory. */
8019 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
8020 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
8021 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
8022 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
8023 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
8024
8025 /* Search for a prefix. */
8026 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
8027 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
8028 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
8029 && dirs[j].length > 1
8030 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
8031 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
8032 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
8033 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
8034
8035 ++ndirs;
8036 }
8037
8038 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
8039 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
8040 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
8041 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
8042 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
8043 results in most cases and never is much off. */
8044 saved = alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
8045 savehere = alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
8046
8047 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
8048 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
8049 {
8050 int j;
8051 int total;
8052
8053 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
8054 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
8055 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
8056 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
8057
8058 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
8059 {
8060 savehere[j] = 0;
8061 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
8062 {
8063 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
8064 dirs[j] path. */
8065 int k;
8066
8067 k = dirs[j].prefix;
8068 while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
8069 k = dirs[k].prefix;
8070
8071 if (k == (int) i)
8072 {
8073 /* Yes it is. We can possibly save some memory by
8074 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
8075 dirs[i]. */
8076 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
8077 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
8078 }
8079 }
8080 }
8081
8082 /* Check whether we can save enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
8083 directory. */
8084 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
8085 {
8086 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
8087 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
8088 if (savehere[j] > 0)
8089 {
8090 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
8091 saved[j] = savehere[j];
8092
8093 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
8094 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
8095 }
8096 }
8097 }
8098
8099 /* Emit the directory name table. */
8100 idx = 1;
8101 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
8102 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
8103 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path, dirs[i].length - 1,
8104 "Directory Entry: 0x%x", i + idx_offset);
8105
8106 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
8107
8108 /* We have to emit them in the order of emitted_number since that's
8109 used in the debug info generation. To do this efficiently we
8110 generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
8111 backmap = alloca (numfiles * sizeof (int));
8112 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
8113 backmap[files[i].file_idx->emitted_number - 1] = i;
8114
8115 /* Now write all the file names. */
8116 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
8117 {
8118 int file_idx = backmap[i];
8119 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
8120
8121 dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
8122 "File Entry: 0x%x", (unsigned) i + 1);
8123
8124 /* Include directory index. */
8125 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
8126
8127 /* Modification time. */
8128 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
8129
8130 /* File length in bytes. */
8131 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
8132 }
8133
8134 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
8135 }
8136
8137
8138 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
8139 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
8140
8141 static void
8142 output_line_info (void)
8143 {
8144 char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
8145 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
8146 char prev_line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
8147 unsigned opc;
8148 unsigned n_op_args;
8149 unsigned long lt_index;
8150 unsigned long current_line;
8151 long line_offset;
8152 long line_delta;
8153 unsigned long current_file;
8154 unsigned long function;
8155
8156 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
8157 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
8158 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
8159 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
8160
8161 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
8162 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
8163 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
8164 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
8165 "Length of Source Line Info");
8166 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
8167
8168 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
8169 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
8170 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
8171
8172 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in
8173 bytes). In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for
8174 information purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language,
8175 we have no a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are
8176 generated for each source line, and therefore can use only the
8177 DW_LNE_set_address and DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information
8178 commands. Accordingly, we fix this as `1', which is "correct
8179 enough" for all architectures, and don't let the target override. */
8180 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1,
8181 "Minimum Instruction Length");
8182
8183 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
8184 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
8185 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
8186 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
8187 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
8188 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
8189 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
8190 "Special Opcode Base");
8191
8192 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
8193 {
8194 switch (opc)
8195 {
8196 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
8197 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
8198 case DW_LNS_set_file:
8199 case DW_LNS_set_column:
8200 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
8201 n_op_args = 1;
8202 break;
8203 default:
8204 n_op_args = 0;
8205 break;
8206 }
8207
8208 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: 0x%x has %d args",
8209 opc, n_op_args);
8210 }
8211
8212 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
8213 output_file_names ();
8214 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
8215
8216 /* We used to set the address register to the first location in the text
8217 section here, but that didn't accomplish anything since we already
8218 have a line note for the opening brace of the first function. */
8219
8220 /* Generate the line number to PC correspondence table, encoded as
8221 a series of state machine operations. */
8222 current_file = 1;
8223 current_line = 1;
8224
8225 if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
8226 strcpy (prev_line_label, crtl->subsections.cold_section_label);
8227 else
8228 strcpy (prev_line_label, text_section_label);
8229 for (lt_index = 1; lt_index < line_info_table_in_use; ++lt_index)
8230 {
8231 dw_line_info_ref line_info = &line_info_table[lt_index];
8232
8233 #if 0
8234 /* Disable this optimization for now; GDB wants to see two line notes
8235 at the beginning of a function so it can find the end of the
8236 prologue. */
8237
8238 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. Just updating the
8239 address doesn't accomplish anything, because we already assume
8240 that anything after the last address is this line. */
8241 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
8242 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file)
8243 continue;
8244 #endif
8245
8246 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line.
8247
8248 Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and must always
8249 use the most general form. GCC does not know the address delta
8250 itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many ports do have length
8251 attributes which will give an upper bound on the address range. We
8252 could perhaps use length attributes to determine when it is safe to
8253 use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
8254
8255 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, lt_index);
8256 if (0)
8257 {
8258 /* This can handle deltas up to 0xffff. This takes 3 bytes. */
8259 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8260 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8261 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8262 }
8263 else
8264 {
8265 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
8266 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
8267 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8268 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8269 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8270 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8271 }
8272
8273 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
8274
8275 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
8276 different from the previous line. */
8277 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
8278 {
8279 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
8280 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
8281 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "%lu", current_file);
8282 }
8283
8284 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
8285 that uses the least amount of space. */
8286 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
8287 {
8288 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
8289 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
8290 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
8291 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
8292 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
8293 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE. This
8294 takes 1 byte. */
8295 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
8296 "line %lu", current_line);
8297 else
8298 {
8299 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
8300 depending on the value being encoded. */
8301 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
8302 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
8303 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
8304 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8305 }
8306 }
8307 else
8308 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
8309 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8310 }
8311
8312 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
8313 if (0)
8314 {
8315 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8316 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8317 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, text_end_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8318 }
8319 else
8320 {
8321 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8322 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8323 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8324 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label, NULL);
8325 }
8326
8327 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
8328 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
8329 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
8330
8331 function = 0;
8332 current_file = 1;
8333 current_line = 1;
8334 for (lt_index = 0; lt_index < separate_line_info_table_in_use;)
8335 {
8336 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info
8337 = &separate_line_info_table[lt_index];
8338
8339 #if 0
8340 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. */
8341 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
8342 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file
8343 && line_info->function == function)
8344 goto cont;
8345 #endif
8346
8347 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line. If this is
8348 a new function, or the first line of a function, then we need
8349 to handle it differently. */
8350 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
8351 lt_index);
8352 if (function != line_info->function)
8353 {
8354 function = line_info->function;
8355
8356 /* Set the address register to the first line in the function. */
8357 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8358 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8359 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8360 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8361 }
8362 else
8363 {
8364 /* ??? See the DW_LNS_advance_pc comment above. */
8365 if (0)
8366 {
8367 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8368 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8369 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8370 }
8371 else
8372 {
8373 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8374 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8375 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8376 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8377 }
8378 }
8379
8380 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
8381
8382 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
8383 different from the previous line. */
8384 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
8385 {
8386 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
8387 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
8388 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "%lu", current_file);
8389 }
8390
8391 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
8392 that uses the least amount of space. */
8393 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
8394 {
8395 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
8396 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
8397 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
8398 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
8399 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
8400 "line %lu", current_line);
8401 else
8402 {
8403 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
8404 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
8405 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
8406 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8407 }
8408 }
8409 else
8410 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8411
8412 #if 0
8413 cont:
8414 #endif
8415
8416 lt_index++;
8417
8418 /* If we're done with a function, end its sequence. */
8419 if (lt_index == separate_line_info_table_in_use
8420 || separate_line_info_table[lt_index].function != function)
8421 {
8422 current_file = 1;
8423 current_line = 1;
8424
8425 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
8426 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, FUNC_END_LABEL, function);
8427 if (0)
8428 {
8429 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8430 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8431 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8432 }
8433 else
8434 {
8435 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8436 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8437 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8438 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8439 }
8440
8441 /* Output the marker for the end of this sequence. */
8442 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
8443 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
8444 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
8445 }
8446 }
8447
8448 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
8449 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
8450 }
8451 \f
8452 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
8453 a DIE that describes the given type.
8454
8455 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
8456 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
8457
8458 static dw_die_ref
8459 base_type_die (tree type)
8460 {
8461 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
8462 enum dwarf_type encoding;
8463
8464 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
8465 return 0;
8466
8467 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8468 {
8469 case INTEGER_TYPE:
8470 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
8471 {
8472 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8473 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
8474 else
8475 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
8476 }
8477 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8478 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
8479 else
8480 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
8481 break;
8482
8483 case REAL_TYPE:
8484 if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
8485 encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
8486 else
8487 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
8488 break;
8489
8490 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
8491 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8492 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed;
8493 else
8494 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_fixed;
8495 break;
8496
8497 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
8498 a user defined type for it. */
8499 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
8500 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
8501 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
8502 else
8503 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
8504 break;
8505
8506 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
8507 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
8508 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
8509 break;
8510
8511 default:
8512 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
8513 gcc_unreachable ();
8514 }
8515
8516 base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8517
8518 /* This probably indicates a bug. */
8519 if (! TYPE_NAME (type))
8520 add_name_attribute (base_type_result, "__unknown__");
8521
8522 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
8523 int_size_in_bytes (type));
8524 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
8525
8526 return base_type_result;
8527 }
8528
8529 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
8530 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
8531
8532 static inline int
8533 is_base_type (tree type)
8534 {
8535 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8536 {
8537 case ERROR_MARK:
8538 case VOID_TYPE:
8539 case INTEGER_TYPE:
8540 case REAL_TYPE:
8541 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
8542 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
8543 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
8544 return 1;
8545
8546 case ARRAY_TYPE:
8547 case RECORD_TYPE:
8548 case UNION_TYPE:
8549 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
8550 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
8551 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
8552 case METHOD_TYPE:
8553 case POINTER_TYPE:
8554 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
8555 case OFFSET_TYPE:
8556 case LANG_TYPE:
8557 case VECTOR_TYPE:
8558 return 0;
8559
8560 default:
8561 gcc_unreachable ();
8562 }
8563
8564 return 0;
8565 }
8566
8567 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
8568 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
8569 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
8570 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
8571 ERROR_MARK node. */
8572
8573 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
8574 simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
8575 {
8576 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
8577 return BITS_PER_WORD;
8578 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
8579 return 0;
8580 else if (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1))
8581 return tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1);
8582 else
8583 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
8584 }
8585
8586 /* Return true if the debug information for the given type should be
8587 emitted as a subrange type. */
8588
8589 static inline bool
8590 is_subrange_type (const_tree type)
8591 {
8592 tree subtype = TREE_TYPE (type);
8593
8594 /* Subrange types are identified by the fact that they are integer
8595 types, and that they have a subtype which is either an integer type
8596 or an enumeral type. */
8597
8598 if (TREE_CODE (type) != INTEGER_TYPE
8599 || subtype == NULL_TREE)
8600 return false;
8601
8602 if (TREE_CODE (subtype) != INTEGER_TYPE
8603 && TREE_CODE (subtype) != ENUMERAL_TYPE)
8604 return false;
8605
8606 if (TREE_CODE (type) == TREE_CODE (subtype)
8607 && int_size_in_bytes (type) == int_size_in_bytes (subtype)
8608 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type) != NULL
8609 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (subtype) != NULL
8610 && tree_int_cst_equal (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type), TYPE_MIN_VALUE (subtype))
8611 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type) != NULL
8612 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (subtype) != NULL
8613 && tree_int_cst_equal (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type), TYPE_MAX_VALUE (subtype)))
8614 {
8615 /* The type and its subtype have the same representation. If in
8616 addition the two types also have the same name, then the given
8617 type is not a subrange type, but rather a plain base type. */
8618 /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-03-22:
8619 Sizetype INTEGER_CSTs nodes are canonicalized. It should
8620 therefore be sufficient to check the TYPE_SIZE node pointers
8621 rather than checking the actual size. Unfortunately, we have
8622 found some cases, such as in the Ada "integer" type, where
8623 this is not the case. Until this problem is solved, we need to
8624 keep checking the actual size. */
8625 tree type_name = TYPE_NAME (type);
8626 tree subtype_name = TYPE_NAME (subtype);
8627
8628 if (type_name != NULL && TREE_CODE (type_name) == TYPE_DECL)
8629 type_name = DECL_NAME (type_name);
8630
8631 if (subtype_name != NULL && TREE_CODE (subtype_name) == TYPE_DECL)
8632 subtype_name = DECL_NAME (subtype_name);
8633
8634 if (type_name == subtype_name)
8635 return false;
8636 }
8637
8638 return true;
8639 }
8640
8641 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
8642 to a DIE that describes the given type. */
8643
8644 static dw_die_ref
8645 subrange_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
8646 {
8647 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
8648 const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
8649
8650 if (context_die == NULL)
8651 context_die = comp_unit_die;
8652
8653 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
8654
8655 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
8656 {
8657 /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
8658 so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type. */
8659 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
8660 }
8661
8662 if (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type) != NULL)
8663 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
8664 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type));
8665 if (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type) != NULL)
8666 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
8667 TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type));
8668
8669 return subrange_die;
8670 }
8671
8672 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
8673 entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type. */
8674
8675 static dw_die_ref
8676 modified_type_die (tree type, int is_const_type, int is_volatile_type,
8677 dw_die_ref context_die)
8678 {
8679 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
8680 dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
8681 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
8682 tree item_type = NULL;
8683 tree qualified_type;
8684 tree name;
8685
8686 if (code == ERROR_MARK)
8687 return NULL;
8688
8689 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
8690 this type. */
8691 qualified_type
8692 = get_qualified_type (type,
8693 ((is_const_type ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : 0)
8694 | (is_volatile_type ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : 0)));
8695
8696 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
8697 if (qualified_type)
8698 {
8699 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
8700 if (mod_type_die)
8701 return mod_type_die;
8702 }
8703
8704 name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
8705
8706 /* Handle C typedef types. */
8707 if (name && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name))
8708 {
8709 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
8710
8711 if (qualified_type == dtype)
8712 {
8713 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
8714 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
8715 return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
8716 }
8717 else if (is_const_type < TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
8718 || is_volatile_type < TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
8719 || (is_const_type <= TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
8720 && is_volatile_type <= TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
8721 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type))
8722 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use the unnamed
8723 type to which it refers. */
8724 return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name),
8725 is_const_type, is_volatile_type,
8726 context_die);
8727 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
8728 }
8729
8730 if (is_const_type)
8731 {
8732 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_const_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8733 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, is_volatile_type, context_die);
8734 }
8735 else if (is_volatile_type)
8736 {
8737 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_volatile_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8738 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, 0, context_die);
8739 }
8740 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE)
8741 {
8742 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8743 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
8744 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
8745 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8746 }
8747 else if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
8748 {
8749 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8750 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
8751 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
8752 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8753 }
8754 else if (is_subrange_type (type))
8755 {
8756 mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, context_die);
8757 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8758 }
8759 else if (is_base_type (type))
8760 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type);
8761 else
8762 {
8763 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
8764
8765 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
8766 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
8767 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
8768 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
8769 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
8770 ..._TYPE node. */
8771 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
8772 return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
8773 else
8774 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
8775 not the main variant. */
8776 return lookup_type_die (type);
8777 }
8778
8779 /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE. For those,
8780 don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
8781 user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type. */
8782 if (name
8783 && (TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL
8784 || (TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type && DECL_NAME (name))))
8785 {
8786 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
8787 /* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
8788 but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
8789 useful source coordinates anyway. */
8790 name = DECL_NAME (name);
8791 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
8792 }
8793
8794 if (qualified_type)
8795 equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
8796
8797 if (item_type)
8798 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
8799 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
8800 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
8801 types are possible in Ada. */
8802 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
8803 TYPE_READONLY (item_type),
8804 TYPE_VOLATILE (item_type),
8805 context_die);
8806
8807 if (sub_die != NULL)
8808 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
8809
8810 return mod_type_die;
8811 }
8812
8813 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
8814 an enumerated type. */
8815
8816 static inline int
8817 type_is_enum (const_tree type)
8818 {
8819 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
8820 }
8821
8822 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node. */
8823
8824 static unsigned int
8825 dbx_reg_number (const_rtx rtl)
8826 {
8827 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
8828
8829 gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
8830
8831 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
8832 if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
8833 {
8834 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
8835 if (leaf_reg != -1)
8836 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
8837 }
8838 #endif
8839
8840 return DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
8841 }
8842
8843 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
8844 DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
8845 doesn't end with DW_OP_piece. */
8846
8847 static void
8848 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
8849 {
8850 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8851
8852 if (*list_head != NULL)
8853 {
8854 /* Find the end of the chain. */
8855 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8856 ;
8857
8858 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
8859 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
8860 }
8861 }
8862
8863 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
8864 zero if there is none. */
8865
8866 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8867 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum var_init_status initialized)
8868 {
8869 rtx regs;
8870
8871 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8872 return 0;
8873
8874 regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
8875
8876 if (hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)] > 1 || regs)
8877 return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs, initialized);
8878 else
8879 return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (rtl), initialized);
8880 }
8881
8882 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
8883 a given hard register number. */
8884
8885 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8886 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno, enum var_init_status initialized)
8887 {
8888 dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descr;
8889 if (regno <= 31)
8890 reg_loc_descr = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + regno, 0, 0);
8891 else
8892 reg_loc_descr = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
8893
8894 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
8895 add_loc_descr (&reg_loc_descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
8896
8897 return reg_loc_descr;
8898 }
8899
8900 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
8901 designates a value that spans more than one register. */
8902
8903 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8904 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs,
8905 enum var_init_status initialized)
8906 {
8907 int nregs, size, i;
8908 unsigned reg;
8909 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
8910
8911 reg = REGNO (rtl);
8912 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
8913 if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
8914 {
8915 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
8916 if (leaf_reg != -1)
8917 reg = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
8918 }
8919 #endif
8920 gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
8921 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)];
8922
8923 /* Simple, contiguous registers. */
8924 if (regs == NULL_RTX)
8925 {
8926 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
8927
8928 loc_result = NULL;
8929 while (nregs--)
8930 {
8931 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
8932
8933 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg),
8934 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
8935 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
8936 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
8937 ++reg;
8938 }
8939 return loc_result;
8940 }
8941
8942 /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations. */
8943
8944 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
8945
8946 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
8947 loc_result = NULL;
8948
8949 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
8950 {
8951 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
8952
8953 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (REGNO (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)),
8954 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
8955 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
8956 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
8957 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
8958 }
8959
8960 if (loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
8961 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
8962 return loc_result;
8963 }
8964
8965 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
8966
8967 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8968 int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
8969 {
8970 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8971
8972 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
8973 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
8974 if (i >= 0)
8975 {
8976 if (i <= 31)
8977 op = DW_OP_lit0 + i;
8978 else if (i <= 0xff)
8979 op = DW_OP_const1u;
8980 else if (i <= 0xffff)
8981 op = DW_OP_const2u;
8982 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
8983 || i <= 0xffffffff)
8984 op = DW_OP_const4u;
8985 else
8986 op = DW_OP_constu;
8987 }
8988 else
8989 {
8990 if (i >= -0x80)
8991 op = DW_OP_const1s;
8992 else if (i >= -0x8000)
8993 op = DW_OP_const2s;
8994 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
8995 || i >= -0x80000000)
8996 op = DW_OP_const4s;
8997 else
8998 op = DW_OP_consts;
8999 }
9000
9001 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
9002 }
9003
9004 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
9005
9006 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9007 based_loc_descr (rtx reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset,
9008 enum var_init_status initialized)
9009 {
9010 unsigned int regno;
9011 dw_loc_descr_ref result;
9012
9013 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
9014 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
9015 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
9016 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's. */
9017 if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
9018 {
9019 rtx elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
9020
9021 if (elim != reg)
9022 {
9023 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
9024 {
9025 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
9026 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
9027 }
9028 gcc_assert (elim == (frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
9029 : stack_pointer_rtx));
9030 offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
9031
9032 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
9033 }
9034 }
9035
9036 regno = dbx_reg_number (reg);
9037 if (regno <= 31)
9038 result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + regno, offset, 0);
9039 else
9040 result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, regno, offset);
9041
9042 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
9043 add_loc_descr (&result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
9044
9045 return result;
9046 }
9047
9048 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
9049
9050 static inline int
9051 is_based_loc (const_rtx rtl)
9052 {
9053 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
9054 && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
9055 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
9056 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT)));
9057 }
9058
9059 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of N locations
9060 used to form the address of a memory location. */
9061
9062 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9063 concatn_mem_loc_descriptor (rtx concatn, enum machine_mode mode,
9064 enum var_init_status initialized)
9065 {
9066 unsigned int i;
9067 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
9068 unsigned int n = XVECLEN (concatn, 0);
9069
9070 for (i = 0; i < n; ++i)
9071 {
9072 dw_loc_descr_ref ref;
9073 rtx x = XVECEXP (concatn, 0, i);
9074
9075 ref = mem_loc_descriptor (x, mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
9076 if (ref == NULL)
9077 return NULL;
9078
9079 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, ref);
9080 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)));
9081 }
9082
9083 if (cc_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
9084 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
9085
9086 return cc_loc_result;
9087 }
9088
9089 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
9090 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
9091 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
9092 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
9093
9094 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
9095 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
9096 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
9097 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
9098
9099 MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
9100 autoincrement addressing modes.
9101
9102 CAN_USE_FBREG is a flag whether we can use DW_AT_frame_base in the
9103 location list for RTL.
9104
9105 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
9106
9107 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9108 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
9109 enum var_init_status initialized)
9110 {
9111 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
9112 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
9113
9114 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
9115 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
9116 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
9117 zeroth element of the array. */
9118
9119 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
9120
9121 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
9122 {
9123 case POST_INC:
9124 case POST_DEC:
9125 case POST_MODIFY:
9126 /* POST_INC and POST_DEC can be handled just like a SUBREG. So we
9127 just fall into the SUBREG code. */
9128
9129 /* ... fall through ... */
9130
9131 case SUBREG:
9132 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
9133 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
9134 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
9135 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
9136 contains the given subreg. */
9137 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9138
9139 /* ... fall through ... */
9140
9141 case REG:
9142 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
9143 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
9144 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
9145 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
9146 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
9147 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
9148 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
9149 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
9150 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
9151 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
9152 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
9153 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
9154 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
9155 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
9156 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
9157 break;
9158
9159 case MEM:
9160 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl),
9161 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
9162 if (mem_loc_result != 0)
9163 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
9164 break;
9165
9166 case LO_SUM:
9167 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
9168
9169 /* ... fall through ... */
9170
9171 case LABEL_REF:
9172 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
9173 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
9174 pool. */
9175 case CONST:
9176 case SYMBOL_REF:
9177 /* Alternatively, the symbol in the constant pool might be referenced
9178 by a different symbol. */
9179 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
9180 {
9181 bool marked;
9182 rtx tmp = get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
9183
9184 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SYMBOL_REF)
9185 {
9186 rtl = tmp;
9187 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (tmp))
9188 get_pool_constant_mark (tmp, &marked);
9189 else
9190 marked = true;
9191 }
9192
9193 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
9194 it was not output and thus we can't represent it.
9195 FIXME: might try to use DW_OP_const_value here, though
9196 DW_OP_piece complicates it. */
9197 if (!marked)
9198 return 0;
9199 }
9200
9201 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
9202 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
9203 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
9204 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
9205 break;
9206
9207 case PRE_MODIFY:
9208 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
9209 PLUS code below. */
9210 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
9211 goto plus;
9212
9213 case PRE_INC:
9214 case PRE_DEC:
9215 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
9216 below. */
9217 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
9218 GEN_INT (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
9219 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)
9220 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)));
9221
9222 /* ... fall through ... */
9223
9224 case PLUS:
9225 plus:
9226 if (is_based_loc (rtl))
9227 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
9228 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)),
9229 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
9230 else
9231 {
9232 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
9233 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
9234 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
9235 break;
9236
9237 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT
9238 && INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) >= 0)
9239 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
9240 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
9241 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)), 0));
9242 else
9243 {
9244 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
9245 mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
9246 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED));
9247 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
9248 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
9249 }
9250 }
9251 break;
9252
9253 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
9254 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift. */
9255 case MULT:
9256 op = DW_OP_mul;
9257 goto do_binop;
9258
9259 case ASHIFT:
9260 op = DW_OP_shl;
9261 goto do_binop;
9262
9263 case ASHIFTRT:
9264 op = DW_OP_shra;
9265 goto do_binop;
9266
9267 case LSHIFTRT:
9268 op = DW_OP_shr;
9269 goto do_binop;
9270
9271 do_binop:
9272 {
9273 dw_loc_descr_ref op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
9274 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
9275 dw_loc_descr_ref op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
9276 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
9277
9278 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
9279 break;
9280
9281 mem_loc_result = op0;
9282 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
9283 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9284 break;
9285 }
9286
9287 case CONST_INT:
9288 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
9289 break;
9290
9291 case CONCATN:
9292 mem_loc_result = concatn_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode,
9293 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
9294 break;
9295
9296 default:
9297 gcc_unreachable ();
9298 }
9299
9300 if (mem_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
9301 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
9302
9303 return mem_loc_result;
9304 }
9305
9306 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
9307 This is typically a complex variable. */
9308
9309 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9310 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1, enum var_init_status initialized)
9311 {
9312 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
9313 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref = loc_descriptor (x0, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
9314 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref = loc_descriptor (x1, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
9315
9316 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
9317 return 0;
9318
9319 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
9320 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)));
9321
9322 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
9323 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)));
9324
9325 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
9326 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
9327
9328 return cc_loc_result;
9329 }
9330
9331 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of N
9332 locations. */
9333
9334 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9335 concatn_loc_descriptor (rtx concatn, enum var_init_status initialized)
9336 {
9337 unsigned int i;
9338 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
9339 unsigned int n = XVECLEN (concatn, 0);
9340
9341 for (i = 0; i < n; ++i)
9342 {
9343 dw_loc_descr_ref ref;
9344 rtx x = XVECEXP (concatn, 0, i);
9345
9346 ref = loc_descriptor (x, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
9347 if (ref == NULL)
9348 return NULL;
9349
9350 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, ref);
9351 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)));
9352 }
9353
9354 if (cc_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
9355 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
9356
9357 return cc_loc_result;
9358 }
9359
9360 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
9361 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
9362 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
9363 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
9364 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
9365
9366 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
9367
9368 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9369 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum var_init_status initialized)
9370 {
9371 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
9372
9373 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
9374 {
9375 case SUBREG:
9376 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
9377 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
9378 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
9379 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
9380 contains the given subreg. */
9381 rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
9382
9383 /* ... fall through ... */
9384
9385 case REG:
9386 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
9387 break;
9388
9389 case MEM:
9390 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl),
9391 initialized);
9392 break;
9393
9394 case CONCAT:
9395 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1),
9396 initialized);
9397 break;
9398
9399 case CONCATN:
9400 loc_result = concatn_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
9401 break;
9402
9403 case VAR_LOCATION:
9404 /* Single part. */
9405 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) != PARALLEL)
9406 {
9407 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 1), 0), initialized);
9408 break;
9409 }
9410
9411 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
9412 /* FALLTHRU */
9413
9414 case PARALLEL:
9415 {
9416 rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
9417 int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
9418 enum machine_mode mode;
9419 int i;
9420
9421 /* Create the first one, so we have something to add to. */
9422 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0),
9423 initialized);
9424 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
9425 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
9426 for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
9427 {
9428 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
9429
9430 temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0),
9431 initialized);
9432 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
9433 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
9434 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
9435 }
9436 }
9437 break;
9438
9439 default:
9440 gcc_unreachable ();
9441 }
9442
9443 return loc_result;
9444 }
9445
9446 /* Similar, but generate the descriptor from trees instead of rtl. This comes
9447 up particularly with variable length arrays. WANT_ADDRESS is 2 if this is
9448 a top-level invocation of loc_descriptor_from_tree; is 1 if this is not a
9449 top-level invocation, and we require the address of LOC; is 0 if we require
9450 the value of LOC. */
9451
9452 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9453 loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (tree loc, int want_address)
9454 {
9455 dw_loc_descr_ref ret, ret1;
9456 int have_address = 0;
9457 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
9458
9459 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
9460 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
9461 problem... */
9462
9463 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
9464 {
9465 case ERROR_MARK:
9466 return 0;
9467
9468 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
9469 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
9470 position of other fields. We don't try to encode this here. The
9471 only user of this is Ada, which encodes the needed information using
9472 the names of types. */
9473 return 0;
9474
9475 case CALL_EXPR:
9476 return 0;
9477
9478 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
9479 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
9480 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
9481 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
9482 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
9483 return 0;
9484
9485 case ADDR_EXPR:
9486 /* If we already want an address, there's nothing we can do. */
9487 if (want_address)
9488 return 0;
9489
9490 /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address. */
9491 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1);
9492
9493 case VAR_DECL:
9494 if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
9495 {
9496 rtx rtl;
9497 unsigned first_op;
9498 unsigned second_op;
9499
9500 if (targetm.have_tls)
9501 {
9502 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the
9503 data. */
9504 if (!targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
9505 return 0;
9506
9507 /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we
9508 can only look up addresses of objects in the current
9509 module. */
9510 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc))
9511 return 0;
9512 first_op = INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr;
9513 second_op = DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address;
9514 }
9515 else
9516 {
9517 if (!targetm.emutls.debug_form_tls_address)
9518 return 0;
9519 loc = emutls_decl (loc);
9520 first_op = DW_OP_addr;
9521 second_op = DW_OP_form_tls_address;
9522 }
9523
9524 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
9525 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
9526 return 0;
9527
9528 if (!MEM_P (rtl))
9529 return 0;
9530 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9531 if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
9532 return 0;
9533
9534 ret = new_loc_descr (first_op, 0, 0);
9535 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
9536 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
9537
9538 ret1 = new_loc_descr (second_op, 0, 0);
9539 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
9540
9541 have_address = 1;
9542 break;
9543 }
9544 /* FALLTHRU */
9545
9546 case PARM_DECL:
9547 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
9548 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
9549 want_address);
9550 /* FALLTHRU */
9551
9552 case RESULT_DECL:
9553 case FUNCTION_DECL:
9554 {
9555 rtx rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
9556
9557 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
9558 return 0;
9559 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_INT)
9560 {
9561 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
9562 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
9563 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
9564 ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
9565 }
9566 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
9567 return 0;
9568 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl))
9569 {
9570 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
9571 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
9572 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
9573 }
9574 else
9575 {
9576 enum machine_mode mode;
9577
9578 /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level. */
9579 if (want_address == 2)
9580 return loc_descriptor (rtl, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
9581
9582 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9583 if (MEM_P (rtl))
9584 {
9585 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9586 have_address = 1;
9587 }
9588 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
9589 }
9590 }
9591 break;
9592
9593 case INDIRECT_REF:
9594 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9595 have_address = 1;
9596 break;
9597
9598 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
9599 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address);
9600
9601 case NOP_EXPR:
9602 case CONVERT_EXPR:
9603 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
9604 case SAVE_EXPR:
9605 case GIMPLE_MODIFY_STMT:
9606 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (GENERIC_TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0),
9607 want_address);
9608
9609 case COMPONENT_REF:
9610 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
9611 case ARRAY_REF:
9612 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
9613 {
9614 tree obj, offset;
9615 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
9616 enum machine_mode mode;
9617 int volatilep;
9618 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
9619
9620 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
9621 &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
9622
9623 if (obj == loc)
9624 return 0;
9625
9626 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (obj, 1);
9627 if (ret == 0
9628 || bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
9629 return 0;
9630
9631 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
9632 {
9633 /* Variable offset. */
9634 add_loc_descr (&ret, loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (offset, 0));
9635 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
9636 }
9637
9638 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
9639 if (bytepos > 0)
9640 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
9641 else if (bytepos < 0)
9642 {
9643 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (bytepos));
9644 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
9645 }
9646
9647 have_address = 1;
9648 break;
9649 }
9650
9651 case INTEGER_CST:
9652 if (host_integerp (loc, 0))
9653 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (loc, 0));
9654 else
9655 return 0;
9656 break;
9657
9658 case CONSTRUCTOR:
9659 {
9660 /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted. */
9661 rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
9662 enum machine_mode mode;
9663
9664 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
9665 return 0;
9666 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9667 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9668 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
9669 have_address = 1;
9670 break;
9671 }
9672
9673 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
9674 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
9675 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
9676 op = DW_OP_and;
9677 goto do_binop;
9678
9679 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
9680 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
9681 op = DW_OP_xor;
9682 goto do_binop;
9683
9684 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
9685 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
9686 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
9687 op = DW_OP_or;
9688 goto do_binop;
9689
9690 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
9691 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
9692 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
9693 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
9694 op = DW_OP_div;
9695 goto do_binop;
9696
9697 case MINUS_EXPR:
9698 op = DW_OP_minus;
9699 goto do_binop;
9700
9701 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
9702 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
9703 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
9704 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
9705 op = DW_OP_mod;
9706 goto do_binop;
9707
9708 case MULT_EXPR:
9709 op = DW_OP_mul;
9710 goto do_binop;
9711
9712 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
9713 op = DW_OP_shl;
9714 goto do_binop;
9715
9716 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
9717 op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
9718 goto do_binop;
9719
9720 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
9721 case PLUS_EXPR:
9722 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
9723 && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0))
9724 {
9725 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9726 if (ret == 0)
9727 return 0;
9728
9729 add_loc_descr (&ret,
9730 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
9731 tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1),
9732 0),
9733 0));
9734 break;
9735 }
9736
9737 op = DW_OP_plus;
9738 goto do_binop;
9739
9740 case LE_EXPR:
9741 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9742 return 0;
9743
9744 op = DW_OP_le;
9745 goto do_binop;
9746
9747 case GE_EXPR:
9748 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9749 return 0;
9750
9751 op = DW_OP_ge;
9752 goto do_binop;
9753
9754 case LT_EXPR:
9755 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9756 return 0;
9757
9758 op = DW_OP_lt;
9759 goto do_binop;
9760
9761 case GT_EXPR:
9762 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9763 return 0;
9764
9765 op = DW_OP_gt;
9766 goto do_binop;
9767
9768 case EQ_EXPR:
9769 op = DW_OP_eq;
9770 goto do_binop;
9771
9772 case NE_EXPR:
9773 op = DW_OP_ne;
9774 goto do_binop;
9775
9776 do_binop:
9777 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9778 ret1 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
9779 if (ret == 0 || ret1 == 0)
9780 return 0;
9781
9782 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
9783 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9784 break;
9785
9786 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
9787 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
9788 op = DW_OP_not;
9789 goto do_unop;
9790
9791 case ABS_EXPR:
9792 op = DW_OP_abs;
9793 goto do_unop;
9794
9795 case NEGATE_EXPR:
9796 op = DW_OP_neg;
9797 goto do_unop;
9798
9799 do_unop:
9800 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9801 if (ret == 0)
9802 return 0;
9803
9804 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9805 break;
9806
9807 case MIN_EXPR:
9808 case MAX_EXPR:
9809 {
9810 const enum tree_code code =
9811 TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
9812
9813 loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
9814 build2 (code, integer_type_node,
9815 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
9816 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
9817 }
9818
9819 /* ... fall through ... */
9820
9821 case COND_EXPR:
9822 {
9823 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
9824 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
9825 dw_loc_descr_ref rhs
9826 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0);
9827 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
9828
9829 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9830 if (ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
9831 return 0;
9832
9833 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
9834 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
9835
9836 add_loc_descr (&ret, rhs);
9837 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
9838 add_loc_descr (&ret, jump_node);
9839
9840 add_loc_descr (&ret, lhs);
9841 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
9842 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
9843
9844 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
9845 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
9846 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
9847 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
9848 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
9849 }
9850 break;
9851
9852 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
9853 return 0;
9854
9855 default:
9856 /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown. This comes
9857 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR. */
9858 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
9859 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
9860 return 0;
9861
9862 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
9863 /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
9864 these explicitly. We forgot one. */
9865 gcc_unreachable ();
9866 #else
9867 /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
9868 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash. */
9869 return NULL;
9870 #endif
9871 }
9872
9873 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
9874 if (want_address && !have_address)
9875 return 0;
9876
9877 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
9878 if (!want_address && have_address && ret)
9879 {
9880 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
9881
9882 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
9883 return 0;
9884 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
9885 op = DW_OP_deref;
9886 else
9887 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
9888
9889 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
9890 }
9891
9892 return ret;
9893 }
9894
9895 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
9896 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc)
9897 {
9898 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (loc, 2);
9899 }
9900
9901 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
9902 which is not less than the value itself. */
9903
9904 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
9905 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
9906 {
9907 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
9908 }
9909
9910 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
9911 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
9912 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
9913 ERROR_MARK node. */
9914
9915 static inline tree
9916 field_type (const_tree decl)
9917 {
9918 tree type;
9919
9920 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
9921 return integer_type_node;
9922
9923 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
9924 if (type == NULL_TREE)
9925 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
9926
9927 return type;
9928 }
9929
9930 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
9931 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
9932 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
9933
9934 static inline unsigned
9935 simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree type)
9936 {
9937 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
9938 }
9939
9940 static inline unsigned
9941 simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree decl)
9942 {
9943 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
9944 }
9945
9946 /* Return the result of rounding T up to ALIGN. */
9947
9948 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
9949 round_up_to_align (HOST_WIDE_INT t, unsigned int align)
9950 {
9951 /* We must be careful if T is negative because HOST_WIDE_INT can be
9952 either "above" or "below" unsigned int as per the C promotion
9953 rules, depending on the host, thus making the signedness of the
9954 direct multiplication and division unpredictable. */
9955 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT u = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) t;
9956
9957 u += align - 1;
9958 u /= align;
9959 u *= align;
9960
9961 return (HOST_WIDE_INT) u;
9962 }
9963
9964 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute and return the byte offset of the
9965 lowest addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL,
9966 or return 0 if we are unable to determine what that offset is, either
9967 because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an ERROR_MARK node, or
9968 because the offset is actually variable. (We can't handle the latter case
9969 just yet). */
9970
9971 static HOST_WIDE_INT
9972 field_byte_offset (const_tree decl)
9973 {
9974 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bits;
9975 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
9976
9977 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
9978 return 0;
9979
9980 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
9981
9982 /* We cannot yet cope with fields whose positions are variable, so
9983 for now, when we see such things, we simply return 0. Someday, we may
9984 be able to handle such cases, but it will be damn difficult. */
9985 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0))
9986 return 0;
9987
9988 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
9989
9990 #ifdef PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
9991 if (PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS)
9992 {
9993 tree type;
9994 tree field_size_tree;
9995 HOST_WIDE_INT deepest_bitpos;
9996 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT field_size_in_bits;
9997 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
9998 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
9999 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT type_size_in_bits;
10000
10001 type = field_type (decl);
10002 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
10003
10004 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
10005 a flexible array member. */
10006 if (! field_size_tree)
10007 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
10008
10009 /* If we don't know the size of the field, pretend it's a full word. */
10010 if (host_integerp (field_size_tree, 1))
10011 field_size_in_bits = tree_low_cst (field_size_tree, 1);
10012 else
10013 field_size_in_bits = BITS_PER_WORD;
10014
10015 type_size_in_bits = simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
10016 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
10017 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
10018
10019 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the
10020 starting bit offset (relative to the start of the containing
10021 structure type) of the hypothetical "containing object" for a
10022 bit-field. Thus, when computing the byte offset value for the
10023 start of the "containing object" of a bit-field, we must deduce
10024 this information on our own. This can be rather tricky to do in
10025 some cases. For example, handling the following structure type
10026 definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only
10027 aligns long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
10028
10029 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
10030
10031 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used
10032 in such cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will
10033 allocate 8 bytes for the structure shown above. It decides to
10034 do this based upon one simple rule for bit-field allocation.
10035 GCC allocates each "containing object" for each bit-field at
10036 the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment boundary
10037 (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared
10038 type of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the
10039 condition that there is still enough available space remaining
10040 in the containing object (when allocated at the selected point)
10041 to fully accommodate all of the bits of the bit-field itself.
10042
10043 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for
10044 each object of the structure type shown above. When looking
10045 for a place to allocate the "containing object" for `field2',
10046 the compiler simply tries to allocate a 64-bit "containing
10047 object" at each successive 32-bit boundary (starting at zero)
10048 until it finds a place to allocate that 64- bit field such that
10049 at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated) bits remain
10050 within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
10051 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the
10052 "containing object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the
10053 structure type.)
10054
10055 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts
10056 we're given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC
10057 must have believed that the containing object started (within
10058 the structure type). The value we deduce is then used (by the
10059 callers of this routine) to generate DW_AT_location and
10060 DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields and, in
10061 the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
10062
10063 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to
10064 the "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
10065 deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
10066
10067 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce
10068 where the lowest addressed bit of the containing object must
10069 be. */
10070 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
10071
10072 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for
10073 bitfields. */
10074 object_offset_in_bits
10075 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, type_align_in_bits);
10076
10077 if (object_offset_in_bits > bitpos_int)
10078 {
10079 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
10080
10081 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
10082 object_offset_in_bits
10083 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, decl_align_in_bits);
10084 }
10085 }
10086 else
10087 #endif
10088 object_offset_in_bits = bitpos_int;
10089
10090 return object_offset_in_bits / BITS_PER_UNIT;
10091 }
10092 \f
10093 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
10094 associated with them. */
10095
10096 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
10097
10098 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
10099 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
10100 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
10101
10102 static inline void
10103 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
10104 dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
10105 {
10106 if (descr != 0)
10107 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr);
10108 }
10109
10110 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
10111 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
10112 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
10113 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
10114 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
10115 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
10116 function above).
10117
10118 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
10119 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
10120 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
10121 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
10122 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
10123 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
10124 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
10125 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
10126 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
10127 function below.) */
10128
10129 static void
10130 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10131 {
10132 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
10133 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
10134
10135 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
10136 {
10137 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
10138 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
10139 {
10140 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
10141 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
10142 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
10143 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
10144
10145 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
10146
10147 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
10148
10149 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
10150
10151 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
10152 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
10153 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
10154
10155 /* Extract the vtable address. */
10156 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
10157 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
10158
10159 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
10160 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl), 0);
10161 gcc_assert (offset < 0);
10162
10163 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
10164 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
10165 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
10166 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
10167
10168 /* Extract the offset. */
10169 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
10170 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
10171
10172 /* Add it to the object address. */
10173 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
10174 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
10175 }
10176 else
10177 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_OFFSET (decl), 0);
10178 }
10179 else
10180 offset = field_byte_offset (decl);
10181
10182 if (! loc_descr)
10183 {
10184 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
10185
10186 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
10187 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure field
10188 address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
10189
10190 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10191 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader does not handle the DW_OP_plus_uconst
10192 operator correctly. It works only if we leave the offset on the
10193 stack. */
10194 op = DW_OP_constu;
10195 #else
10196 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
10197 #endif
10198
10199 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
10200 }
10201
10202 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
10203 }
10204
10205 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array. */
10206
10207 static void
10208 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
10209 {
10210 while (size != 0)
10211 {
10212 *dest++ = val & 0xff;
10213 val >>= 8;
10214 --size;
10215 }
10216 }
10217
10218 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array. Inverse of insert_int. */
10219
10220 static HOST_WIDE_INT
10221 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
10222 {
10223 HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
10224
10225 src += size;
10226 while (size != 0)
10227 {
10228 val <<= 8;
10229 val |= *--src & 0xff;
10230 --size;
10231 }
10232 return val;
10233 }
10234
10235 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array. */
10236
10237 static void
10238 insert_float (const_rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
10239 {
10240 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
10241 long val[4];
10242 int i;
10243
10244 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, rtl);
10245 real_to_target (val, &rv, GET_MODE (rtl));
10246
10247 /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long. Pack them. */
10248 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / 4; i++)
10249 {
10250 insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
10251 array += 4;
10252 }
10253 }
10254
10255 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
10256 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
10257 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
10258 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
10259 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
10260
10261 static void
10262 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
10263 {
10264 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
10265 {
10266 case CONST_INT:
10267 {
10268 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
10269
10270 if (val < 0)
10271 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
10272 else
10273 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
10274 }
10275 break;
10276
10277 case CONST_DOUBLE:
10278 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
10279 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
10280 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
10281 represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
10282 {
10283 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
10284
10285 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
10286 {
10287 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
10288 unsigned char *array = ggc_alloc (length);
10289
10290 insert_float (rtl, array);
10291 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
10292 }
10293 else
10294 {
10295 /* ??? We really should be using HOST_WIDE_INT throughout. */
10296 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
10297
10298 add_AT_long_long (die, DW_AT_const_value,
10299 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
10300 }
10301 }
10302 break;
10303
10304 case CONST_VECTOR:
10305 {
10306 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
10307 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
10308 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
10309 unsigned char *array = ggc_alloc (length * elt_size);
10310 unsigned int i;
10311 unsigned char *p;
10312
10313 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
10314 {
10315 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
10316 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
10317 {
10318 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
10319 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi;
10320
10321 switch (GET_CODE (elt))
10322 {
10323 case CONST_INT:
10324 lo = INTVAL (elt);
10325 hi = -(lo < 0);
10326 break;
10327
10328 case CONST_DOUBLE:
10329 lo = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (elt);
10330 hi = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (elt);
10331 break;
10332
10333 default:
10334 gcc_unreachable ();
10335 }
10336
10337 if (elt_size <= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
10338 insert_int (lo, elt_size, p);
10339 else
10340 {
10341 unsigned char *p0 = p;
10342 unsigned char *p1 = p + sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
10343
10344 gcc_assert (elt_size == 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
10345 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
10346 {
10347 p0 = p1;
10348 p1 = p;
10349 }
10350 insert_int (lo, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p0);
10351 insert_int (hi, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p1);
10352 }
10353 }
10354 break;
10355
10356 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
10357 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
10358 {
10359 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
10360 insert_float (elt, p);
10361 }
10362 break;
10363
10364 default:
10365 gcc_unreachable ();
10366 }
10367
10368 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
10369 }
10370 break;
10371
10372 case CONST_STRING:
10373 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (rtl, 0));
10374 break;
10375
10376 case SYMBOL_REF:
10377 case LABEL_REF:
10378 case CONST:
10379 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_const_value, rtl);
10380 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
10381 break;
10382
10383 case PLUS:
10384 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
10385 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
10386 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
10387 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
10388 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
10389 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
10390 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
10391 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
10392 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
10393 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
10394 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
10395 break;
10396
10397 default:
10398 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
10399 gcc_unreachable ();
10400 }
10401
10402 }
10403
10404 /* Determine whether the evaluation of EXPR references any variables
10405 or functions which aren't otherwise used (and therefore may not be
10406 output). */
10407 static tree
10408 reference_to_unused (tree * tp, int * walk_subtrees,
10409 void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10410 {
10411 if (! EXPR_P (*tp) && ! GIMPLE_STMT_P (*tp) && ! CONSTANT_CLASS_P (*tp))
10412 *walk_subtrees = 0;
10413
10414 if (DECL_P (*tp) && ! TREE_PUBLIC (*tp) && ! TREE_USED (*tp)
10415 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
10416 return *tp;
10417 else if (!flag_unit_at_a_time)
10418 return NULL_TREE;
10419 /* ??? The C++ FE emits debug information for using decls, so
10420 putting gcc_unreachable here falls over. See PR31899. For now
10421 be conservative. */
10422 else if (!cgraph_global_info_ready
10423 && (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL))
10424 return *tp;
10425 else if (DECL_P (*tp) && TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL)
10426 {
10427 struct varpool_node *node = varpool_node (*tp);
10428 if (!node->needed)
10429 return *tp;
10430 }
10431 else if (DECL_P (*tp) && TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL
10432 && (!DECL_EXTERNAL (*tp) || DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (*tp)))
10433 {
10434 struct cgraph_node *node = cgraph_node (*tp);
10435 if (!node->output)
10436 return *tp;
10437 }
10438 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == STRING_CST && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
10439 return *tp;
10440
10441 return NULL_TREE;
10442 }
10443
10444 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
10445 for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call. */
10446
10447 static rtx
10448 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
10449 {
10450 rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
10451
10452 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
10453 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
10454 if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
10455 {
10456 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
10457 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
10458 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
10459
10460 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
10461 && domain
10462 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
10463 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
10464 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
10465 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
10466 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
10467 rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
10468 ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
10469 }
10470 /* Other aggregates, and complex values, could be represented using
10471 CONCAT: FIXME! */
10472 else if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type) || TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
10473 ;
10474 /* Vectors only work if their mode is supported by the target.
10475 FIXME: generic vectors ought to work too. */
10476 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE && TYPE_MODE (type) == BLKmode)
10477 ;
10478 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
10479 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. We must be careful not to
10480 reference variables which won't be output. */
10481 else if (initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type)
10482 && ! walk_tree (&init, reference_to_unused, NULL, NULL))
10483 {
10484 /* Convert vector CONSTRUCTOR initializers to VECTOR_CST if
10485 possible. */
10486 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
10487 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
10488 {
10489 case VECTOR_CST:
10490 break;
10491 case CONSTRUCTOR:
10492 if (TREE_CONSTANT (init))
10493 {
10494 VEC(constructor_elt,gc) *elts = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
10495 bool constant_p = true;
10496 tree value;
10497 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
10498
10499 /* Even when ctor is constant, it might contain non-*_CST
10500 elements (e.g. { 1.0/0.0 - 1.0/0.0, 0.0 }) and those don't
10501 belong into VECTOR_CST nodes. */
10502 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (elts, ix, value)
10503 if (!CONSTANT_CLASS_P (value))
10504 {
10505 constant_p = false;
10506 break;
10507 }
10508
10509 if (constant_p)
10510 {
10511 init = build_vector_from_ctor (type, elts);
10512 break;
10513 }
10514 }
10515 /* FALLTHRU */
10516
10517 default:
10518 return NULL;
10519 }
10520
10521 rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
10522
10523 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
10524 gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
10525 }
10526
10527 return rtl;
10528 }
10529
10530 /* This is a specialized subset of expand_expr to evaluate a DECL_VALUE_EXPR.
10531 We stop if we find decls that haven't been expanded, or if the expression is
10532 getting so complex we won't be able to represent it anyway. Returns NULL on
10533 failure. */
10534
10535 static rtx
10536 dw_expand_expr (tree expr)
10537 {
10538 switch (TREE_CODE (expr))
10539 {
10540 case VAR_DECL:
10541 case PARM_DECL:
10542 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (expr))
10543 return dw_expand_expr (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (expr));
10544 /* FALLTHRU */
10545
10546 case CONST_DECL:
10547 case RESULT_DECL:
10548 return DECL_RTL_IF_SET (expr);
10549
10550 case INTEGER_CST:
10551 return expand_expr (expr, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
10552
10553 case COMPONENT_REF:
10554 case ARRAY_REF:
10555 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
10556 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
10557 {
10558 enum machine_mode mode;
10559 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
10560 tree offset, tem;
10561 int volatilep = 0, unsignedp = 0;
10562 rtx x;
10563
10564 tem = get_inner_reference (expr, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
10565 &mode, &unsignedp, &volatilep, true);
10566
10567 x = dw_expand_expr (tem);
10568 if (x == NULL || !MEM_P (x))
10569 return NULL;
10570 if (offset != NULL)
10571 {
10572 if (!host_integerp (offset, 0))
10573 return NULL;
10574 x = adjust_address_nv (x, mode, tree_low_cst (offset, 0));
10575 }
10576 if (bitpos != 0)
10577 x = adjust_address_nv (x, mode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
10578
10579 return x;
10580 }
10581
10582 default:
10583 return NULL;
10584 }
10585 }
10586
10587 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location. */
10588
10589 static rtx
10590 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
10591 {
10592 rtx rtl;
10593
10594 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
10595 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
10596 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
10597
10598 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
10599 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
10600 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
10601 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
10602 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
10603 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
10604 referenced within the function.
10605
10606 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
10607 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
10608 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
10609 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
10610
10611 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
10612 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
10613 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
10614 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
10615 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
10616 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
10617
10618 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
10619 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
10620 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
10621 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
10622 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
10623 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
10624 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
10625 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
10626 output at debug-time.
10627
10628 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
10629 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
10630 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
10631 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
10632 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
10633 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
10634 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
10635 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
10636 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
10637 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
10638 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
10639 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
10640 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
10641
10642 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
10643 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
10644 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
10645 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
10646 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
10647 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
10648 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
10649 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
10650 I'd like to fix it.
10651
10652 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
10653 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
10654 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
10655 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
10656 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
10657 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
10658 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
10659 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
10660 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
10661 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
10662 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values. FIXME. */
10663
10664 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
10665 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
10666
10667 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
10668 constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
10669 fixed registers. */
10670 if (! reload_completed)
10671 {
10672 if (rtl
10673 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
10674 || (MEM_P (rtl)
10675 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
10676 || (REG_P (rtl)
10677 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
10678 && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
10679 {
10680 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
10681 return rtl;
10682 }
10683 rtl = NULL_RTX;
10684 }
10685 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
10686 {
10687 if (rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
10688 {
10689 tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
10690 tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
10691 enum machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
10692 enum machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
10693
10694 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
10695 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
10696 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
10697 if (dmode == pmode)
10698 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
10699 else if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
10700 && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
10701 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
10702 {
10703 rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
10704 if (REG_P (inc))
10705 rtl = inc;
10706 else if (MEM_P (inc))
10707 {
10708 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10709 rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
10710 GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
10711 - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
10712 else
10713 rtl = inc;
10714 }
10715 }
10716 }
10717
10718 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
10719 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
10720 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
10721 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
10722 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
10723 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
10724 thing to do. */
10725 else if (MEM_P (rtl)
10726 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
10727 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
10728 /* Not passed in memory. */
10729 && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
10730 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
10731 && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
10732 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
10733 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
10734 #if ARG_POINTER_REGNUM != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
10735 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
10736 #endif
10737 )
10738 /* Big endian correction check. */
10739 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
10740 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
10741 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
10742 < UNITS_PER_WORD))
10743 {
10744 int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
10745 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
10746
10747 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10748 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
10749 }
10750 }
10751 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
10752 && rtl
10753 && MEM_P (rtl)
10754 && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
10755 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10756 {
10757 int rsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
10758 int dsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
10759
10760 /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
10761 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
10762 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
10763 fact we are not. We need to adjust the offset of the
10764 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
10765 else gdb will not be able to display it. */
10766 if (rsize > dsize)
10767 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10768 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), rsize-dsize));
10769 }
10770
10771 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
10772 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
10773 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
10774 if (!rtl && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
10775 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
10776
10777 if (rtl)
10778 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
10779
10780 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
10781 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
10782 code, and thus is not emitted. */
10783 if (rtl)
10784 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
10785
10786 return rtl;
10787 }
10788
10789 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
10790 address ranges where a given location is valid.
10791 1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
10792 2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
10793 3. Otherwise, use the text section.
10794 XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice. */
10795
10796 static const char *
10797 secname_for_decl (const_tree decl)
10798 {
10799 const char *secname;
10800
10801 if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl) && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
10802 {
10803 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
10804 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
10805 }
10806 else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
10807 {
10808 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
10809 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
10810 }
10811 else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
10812 secname = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
10813 else
10814 secname = text_section_label;
10815
10816 return secname;
10817 }
10818
10819 /* Check whether decl is a Fortran COMMON symbol. If not, NULL_RTX is returned.
10820 If so, the rtx for the SYMBOL_REF for the COMMON block is returned, and the
10821 value is the offset into the common block for the symbol. */
10822
10823 static rtx
10824 common_check (tree decl, HOST_WIDE_INT *value)
10825 {
10826 rtx home;
10827 rtx sym_addr;
10828 rtx res = NULL_RTX;
10829
10830 /* If the decl isn't a VAR_DECL, or if it isn't public or static, or if
10831 it does not have a value (the offset into the common area), or if it
10832 is thread local (as opposed to global) then it isn't common, and shouldn't
10833 be handled as such. */
10834 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL
10835 || !TREE_PUBLIC(decl)
10836 || !TREE_STATIC(decl)
10837 || !DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P(decl)
10838 || DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (decl)
10839 || !is_fortran())
10840 return NULL;
10841
10842 home = DECL_RTL (decl);
10843 if (home == NULL_RTX || GET_CODE (home) != MEM)
10844 return NULL;
10845
10846 sym_addr = dw_expand_expr (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (decl));
10847 if (sym_addr == NULL_RTX || GET_CODE (sym_addr) != MEM)
10848 return NULL;
10849
10850 sym_addr = XEXP (sym_addr, 0);
10851 if (GET_CODE (sym_addr) == CONST)
10852 sym_addr = XEXP (sym_addr, 0);
10853 if ((GET_CODE (sym_addr) == SYMBOL_REF || GET_CODE (sym_addr) == PLUS)
10854 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) == 0)
10855 {
10856
10857 /* We have a sym that will go into a common area, meaning that it
10858 will get storage reserved with a .comm/.lcomm assembler pseudo-op.
10859
10860 Determine name of common area this symbol will be an offset into,
10861 and offset into that area. Also retrieve the decl for the area
10862 that the symbol is offset into. */
10863 tree cdecl = NULL;
10864
10865 switch (GET_CODE (sym_addr))
10866 {
10867 case PLUS:
10868 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (sym_addr, 0)) == CONST_INT)
10869 {
10870 res = XEXP (sym_addr, 1);
10871 *value = INTVAL (XEXP (sym_addr, 0));
10872 cdecl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (sym_addr, 1));
10873 }
10874 else
10875 {
10876 res = XEXP (sym_addr, 0);
10877 *value = INTVAL (XEXP (sym_addr, 1));
10878 cdecl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (sym_addr, 0));
10879 }
10880 break;
10881
10882 case SYMBOL_REF:
10883 res = sym_addr;
10884 *value = 0;
10885 cdecl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (sym_addr);
10886 break;
10887
10888 default:
10889 error ("common symbol debug info is not structured as "
10890 "symbol+offset");
10891 }
10892
10893 /* Check area common symbol is offset into. If this is not public, then
10894 it is not a symbol in a common block. It must be a .lcomm symbol, not
10895 a .comm symbol. */
10896 if (cdecl == NULL || !TREE_PUBLIC(cdecl))
10897 res = NULL_RTX;
10898 }
10899 else
10900 res = NULL_RTX;
10901
10902 return res;
10903 }
10904
10905
10906 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
10907 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
10908 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
10909 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
10910 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
10911 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
10912 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
10913 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
10914 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
10915 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address. */
10916
10917 static void
10918 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl,
10919 enum dwarf_attribute attr)
10920 {
10921 rtx rtl;
10922 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
10923 var_loc_list *loc_list;
10924 struct var_loc_node *node;
10925 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
10926 return;
10927
10928 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
10929 || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
10930
10931 /* See if we possibly have multiple locations for this variable. */
10932 loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
10933
10934 /* If it truly has multiple locations, the first and last node will
10935 differ. */
10936 if (loc_list && loc_list->first != loc_list->last)
10937 {
10938 const char *endname, *secname;
10939 dw_loc_list_ref list;
10940 rtx varloc;
10941 enum var_init_status initialized;
10942
10943 /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
10944 actually construct the list of locations.
10945 The first location information is what is passed to the
10946 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
10947 locations just get added on to that list.
10948 Note that we only know the start address for a location
10949 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
10950 the range [current location start, next location start].
10951 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
10952 a range of [last location start, end of function label]. */
10953
10954 node = loc_list->first;
10955 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10956 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
10957
10958 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note))
10959 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->var_loc_note);
10960 else
10961 initialized = VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED;
10962
10963 list = new_loc_list (loc_descriptor (varloc, initialized),
10964 node->label, node->next->label, secname, 1);
10965 node = node->next;
10966
10967 for (; node->next; node = node->next)
10968 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
10969 {
10970 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
10971 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
10972 enum var_init_status initialized =
10973 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->var_loc_note);
10974 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10975 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list,
10976 loc_descriptor (varloc, initialized),
10977 node->label, node->next->label, secname);
10978 }
10979
10980 /* If the variable has a location at the last label
10981 it keeps its location until the end of function. */
10982 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
10983 {
10984 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10985 enum var_init_status initialized =
10986 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->var_loc_note);
10987
10988 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10989 if (!current_function_decl)
10990 endname = text_end_label;
10991 else
10992 {
10993 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
10994 current_function_funcdef_no);
10995 endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
10996 }
10997 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list,
10998 loc_descriptor (varloc, initialized),
10999 node->label, endname, secname);
11000 }
11001
11002 /* Finally, add the location list to the DIE, and we are done. */
11003 add_AT_loc_list (die, attr, list);
11004 return;
11005 }
11006
11007 /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
11008 the location. */
11009
11010 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
11011 if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING))
11012 {
11013 add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
11014 return;
11015 }
11016
11017 /* If we have tried to generate the location otherwise, and it
11018 didn't work out (we wouldn't be here if we did), and we have a one entry
11019 location list, try generating a location from that. */
11020 if (loc_list && loc_list->first)
11021 {
11022 enum var_init_status status;
11023 node = loc_list->first;
11024 status = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->var_loc_note);
11025 descr = loc_descriptor (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note), status);
11026 if (descr)
11027 {
11028 add_AT_location_description (die, attr, descr);
11029 return;
11030 }
11031 }
11032
11033 /* We couldn't get any rtl, so try directly generating the location
11034 description from the tree. */
11035 descr = loc_descriptor_from_tree (decl);
11036 if (descr)
11037 {
11038 add_AT_location_description (die, attr, descr);
11039 return;
11040 }
11041 /* None of that worked, so it must not really have a location;
11042 try adding a constant value attribute from the DECL_INITIAL. */
11043 tree_add_const_value_attribute (die, decl);
11044 }
11045
11046 /* If we don't have a copy of this variable in memory for some reason (such
11047 as a C++ member constant that doesn't have an out-of-line definition),
11048 we should tell the debugger about the constant value. */
11049
11050 static void
11051 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
11052 {
11053 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
11054 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
11055 rtx rtl;
11056
11057 if (TREE_READONLY (decl) && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl) && init)
11058 /* OK */;
11059 else
11060 return;
11061
11062 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
11063 if (rtl)
11064 add_const_value_attribute (var_die, rtl);
11065 }
11066
11067 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
11068 location list. This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
11069 a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
11070 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
11071 expressions. */
11072
11073 static dw_loc_list_ref
11074 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
11075 {
11076 dw_fde_ref fde;
11077 dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
11078 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
11079 dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
11080 const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
11081
11082 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
11083
11084 section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
11085 list_tail = &list;
11086 list = NULL;
11087
11088 next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
11089 next_cfa.offset = 0;
11090 next_cfa.indirect = 0;
11091 next_cfa.base_offset = 0;
11092
11093 start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
11094
11095 /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
11096 advance opcodes. */
11097 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
11098 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa);
11099
11100 last_cfa = next_cfa;
11101 last_label = start_label;
11102
11103 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
11104 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
11105 {
11106 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
11107 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
11108 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
11109 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
11110 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
11111 {
11112 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
11113 start_label, last_label, section,
11114 list == NULL);
11115
11116 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
11117 last_cfa = next_cfa;
11118 start_label = last_label;
11119 }
11120 last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
11121 break;
11122
11123 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
11124 /* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this. */
11125 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
11126 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
11127 /* We don't handle these two in this function. It would be possible
11128 if it were to be required. */
11129 gcc_unreachable ();
11130
11131 default:
11132 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa);
11133 break;
11134 }
11135
11136 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
11137 {
11138 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
11139 start_label, last_label, section,
11140 list == NULL);
11141 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
11142 start_label = last_label;
11143 }
11144 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
11145 start_label, fde->dw_fde_end, section,
11146 list == NULL);
11147
11148 return list;
11149 }
11150
11151 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
11152 frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
11153 frame_pointer_fb_offset. OFFSET is added to the displacement
11154 before the latter is negated. */
11155
11156 static void
11157 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
11158 {
11159 rtx reg, elim;
11160
11161 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
11162 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
11163 offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
11164 #else
11165 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
11166 offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
11167 #endif
11168
11169 elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
11170 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
11171 {
11172 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
11173 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
11174 }
11175 gcc_assert (elim == (frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
11176 : stack_pointer_rtx));
11177
11178 frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
11179 }
11180
11181 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
11182 the value of the attribute. */
11183
11184 static void
11185 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
11186 {
11187 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
11188 {
11189 if (demangle_name_func)
11190 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
11191
11192 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
11193 }
11194 }
11195
11196 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE. */
11197
11198 static void
11199 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
11200 {
11201 const char *wd = get_src_pwd ();
11202 if (wd != NULL)
11203 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, remap_debug_filename (wd));
11204 }
11205
11206 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
11207 a representation for that bound. */
11208
11209 static void
11210 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr, tree bound)
11211 {
11212 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
11213 {
11214 case ERROR_MARK:
11215 return;
11216
11217 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. */
11218 case INTEGER_CST:
11219 if (! host_integerp (bound, 0)
11220 || (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
11221 && (((is_c_family () || is_java ()) && integer_zerop (bound))
11222 || (is_fortran () && integer_onep (bound)))))
11223 /* Use the default. */
11224 ;
11225 else
11226 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr, tree_low_cst (bound, 0));
11227 break;
11228
11229 case CONVERT_EXPR:
11230 case NOP_EXPR:
11231 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
11232 add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0));
11233 break;
11234
11235 case SAVE_EXPR:
11236 break;
11237
11238 case VAR_DECL:
11239 case PARM_DECL:
11240 case RESULT_DECL:
11241 {
11242 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (bound);
11243
11244 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
11245 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
11246 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
11247 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
11248 later parameter. */
11249 if (decl_die != NULL)
11250 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
11251 break;
11252 }
11253
11254 default:
11255 {
11256 /* Otherwise try to create a stack operation procedure to
11257 evaluate the value of the array bound. */
11258
11259 dw_die_ref ctx, decl_die;
11260 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
11261
11262 loc = loc_descriptor_from_tree (bound);
11263 if (loc == NULL)
11264 break;
11265
11266 if (current_function_decl == 0)
11267 ctx = comp_unit_die;
11268 else
11269 ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
11270
11271 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
11272 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11273 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
11274 add_AT_loc (decl_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
11275
11276 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
11277 break;
11278 }
11279 }
11280 }
11281
11282 /* Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
11283 includes information about the element type of type given array type. */
11284
11285 static void
11286 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type)
11287 {
11288 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11289 unsigned dimension_number;
11290 #endif
11291 tree lower, upper;
11292 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
11293
11294 /* The GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of
11295 one dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array
11296 types. Here we squish that down, so that each multidimensional array
11297 type gets only one array_type DIE in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft
11298 Dwarf specification say that we are allowed to do this kind of
11299 compression in C (because there is no difference between an array or
11300 arrays and a multidimensional array in C) but for other source languages
11301 (e.g. Ada) we probably shouldn't do this. */
11302
11303 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
11304 const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
11305 We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
11306 gen_array_type_die. */
11307 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11308 for (dimension_number = 0;
11309 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE;
11310 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
11311 #endif
11312 {
11313 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
11314
11315 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
11316 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
11317 here. */
11318 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
11319 if (domain)
11320 {
11321 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
11322 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
11323 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
11324
11325 /* Define the index type. */
11326 if (TREE_TYPE (domain))
11327 {
11328 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
11329 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
11330 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
11331 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
11332 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
11333 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
11334 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
11335 ;
11336 else
11337 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain), 0, 0,
11338 type_die);
11339 }
11340
11341 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
11342 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
11343 dimension arr(N:*)
11344 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
11345 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
11346 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
11347
11348 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower);
11349 if (upper)
11350 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper);
11351 }
11352
11353 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
11354 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
11355 bounds. */
11356 }
11357 }
11358
11359 static void
11360 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
11361 {
11362 unsigned size;
11363
11364 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
11365 {
11366 case ERROR_MARK:
11367 size = 0;
11368 break;
11369 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
11370 case RECORD_TYPE:
11371 case UNION_TYPE:
11372 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
11373 size = int_size_in_bytes (tree_node);
11374 break;
11375 case FIELD_DECL:
11376 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
11377 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
11378 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
11379 even for bit-fields. */
11380 size = simple_type_size_in_bits (field_type (tree_node)) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
11381 break;
11382 default:
11383 gcc_unreachable ();
11384 }
11385
11386 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
11387 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable. We
11388 have no good way of expressing this fact in Dwarf at the present time,
11389 so just let the -1 pass on through. */
11390 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
11391 }
11392
11393 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
11394 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
11395 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
11396 bit-field itself.
11397
11398 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
11399 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
11400 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
11401 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
11402 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
11403 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
11404
11405 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
11406 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
11407 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
11408
11409 static inline void
11410 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
11411 {
11412 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes = field_byte_offset (decl);
11413 tree type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
11414 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
11415 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
11416 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
11417 HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned bit_offset;
11418
11419 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
11420 gcc_assert (type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
11421
11422 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
11423 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
11424 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
11425 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0)
11426 || ! host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
11427 return;
11428
11429 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
11430
11431 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
11432 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
11433 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
11434 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
11435 below must take account of these differences. */
11436 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
11437 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
11438
11439 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
11440 {
11441 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 0);
11442 highest_order_object_bit_offset += simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
11443 }
11444
11445 bit_offset
11446 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
11447 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
11448 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
11449
11450 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
11451 }
11452
11453 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
11454 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
11455
11456 static inline void
11457 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
11458 {
11459 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
11460 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
11461 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
11462
11463 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
11464 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1));
11465 }
11466
11467 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
11468 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
11469
11470 static inline void
11471 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
11472 {
11473 if (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language) == DW_LANG_C89
11474 && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (func_type) != NULL)
11475 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
11476 }
11477
11478 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
11479 by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
11480 equate table. */
11481
11482 static inline void
11483 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
11484 {
11485 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
11486
11487 if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL)
11488 {
11489 /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
11490 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
11491 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
11492
11493 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
11494 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline. */
11495 tree fn = origin;
11496
11497 if (TYPE_P (fn))
11498 fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
11499
11500 fn = decl_function_context (fn);
11501 if (fn)
11502 dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
11503 }
11504
11505 if (DECL_P (origin))
11506 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
11507 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
11508 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
11509
11510 /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
11511 trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
11512 languages). For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
11513 output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases. Rather
11514 than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
11515 have variables without a proper abstract origin. In the future, when all
11516 functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
11517 here. */
11518
11519 if (origin_die)
11520 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
11521 }
11522
11523 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
11524
11525 static inline void
11526 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
11527 {
11528 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
11529 {
11530 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
11531
11532 if (host_integerp (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0))
11533 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
11534 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
11535 tree_low_cst (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0),
11536 0));
11537
11538 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
11539 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11540 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
11541 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
11542 }
11543 }
11544 \f
11545 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
11546
11547 static void
11548 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
11549 {
11550 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
11551
11552 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
11553 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
11554 }
11555
11556 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
11557 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
11558
11559 static void
11560 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
11561 {
11562 tree decl_name;
11563
11564 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
11565 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
11566 {
11567 add_name_attribute (die, dwarf2_name (decl, 0));
11568 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
11569 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
11570
11571 if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
11572 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
11573 && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl)
11574 && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
11575 && !(TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_REGISTER (decl))
11576 && !is_fortran ())
11577 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name,
11578 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)));
11579 }
11580
11581 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11582 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
11583 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
11584 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
11585 {
11586 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
11587 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
11588 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
11589 }
11590 #endif
11591 }
11592
11593 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
11594
11595 static void
11596 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
11597 {
11598 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, decl_scope_table, scope);
11599 }
11600
11601 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
11602
11603 static inline void
11604 pop_decl_scope (void)
11605 {
11606 VEC_pop (tree, decl_scope_table);
11607 }
11608
11609 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
11610 Non-named types get global scope. Named types nested in other
11611 types get their containing scope if it's open, or global scope
11612 otherwise. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
11613 the current active scope. */
11614
11615 static dw_die_ref
11616 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
11617 {
11618 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
11619 tree containing_scope;
11620 int i;
11621
11622 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
11623 gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
11624
11625 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
11626
11627 /* Use the containing namespace if it was passed in (for a declaration). */
11628 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
11629 {
11630 if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
11631 /* OK */;
11632 else
11633 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
11634 }
11635
11636 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
11637 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
11638 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
11639 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
11640 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
11641
11642 if (containing_scope == NULL_TREE)
11643 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
11644 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
11645 {
11646 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. But
11647 first we check to see if we're in the middle of emitting it
11648 so we know where the new DIE should go. */
11649 for (i = VEC_length (tree, decl_scope_table) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
11650 if (VEC_index (tree, decl_scope_table, i) == containing_scope)
11651 break;
11652
11653 if (i < 0)
11654 {
11655 gcc_assert (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
11656 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (containing_scope));
11657
11658 /* If none of the current dies are suitable, we get file scope. */
11659 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
11660 }
11661 else
11662 scope_die = lookup_type_die (containing_scope);
11663 }
11664 else
11665 scope_die = context_die;
11666
11667 return scope_die;
11668 }
11669
11670 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
11671
11672 static inline int
11673 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
11674 {
11675 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
11676 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
11677 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
11678 return 1;
11679
11680 return 0;
11681 }
11682
11683 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
11684 whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration. */
11685
11686 static inline int
11687 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
11688 {
11689 return (context_die
11690 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
11691 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
11692 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_interface_type
11693 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type
11694 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
11695 }
11696
11697 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
11698 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
11699 by 'type', and adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
11700
11701 static void
11702 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int decl_const,
11703 int decl_volatile, dw_die_ref context_die)
11704 {
11705 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
11706 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
11707
11708 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral, floating-point
11709 or fixed-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
11710 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
11711 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
11712 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE || code == FIXED_POINT_TYPE)
11713 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
11714 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
11715
11716 if (code == ERROR_MARK
11717 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
11718 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
11719 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
11720 || code == VOID_TYPE)
11721 return;
11722
11723 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
11724 decl_const || TYPE_READONLY (type),
11725 decl_volatile || TYPE_VOLATILE (type),
11726 context_die);
11727
11728 if (type_die != NULL)
11729 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
11730 }
11731
11732 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
11733 function call type. */
11734 static void
11735 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree decl)
11736 {
11737 enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
11738
11739 value = targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (TREE_TYPE (decl));
11740
11741 /* DWARF doesn't provide a way to identify a program's source-level
11742 entry point. DW_AT_calling_convention attributes are only meant
11743 to describe functions' calling conventions. However, lacking a
11744 better way to signal the Fortran main program, we use this for the
11745 time being, following existing custom. */
11746 if (is_fortran ()
11747 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)), "MAIN__"))
11748 value = DW_CC_program;
11749
11750 /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
11751 is not DW_CC_normal. */
11752 if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
11753 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
11754 }
11755
11756 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
11757 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
11758 was declared without a tag. */
11759
11760 static const char *
11761 type_tag (const_tree type)
11762 {
11763 const char *name = 0;
11764
11765 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
11766 {
11767 tree t = 0;
11768
11769 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
11770 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
11771 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
11772
11773 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
11774 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
11775 involved. */
11776 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
11777 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
11778 {
11779 /* We want to be extra verbose. Don't call dwarf_name if
11780 DECL_NAME isn't set. The default hook for decl_printable_name
11781 doesn't like that, and in this context it's correct to return
11782 0, instead of "<anonymous>" or the like. */
11783 if (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)))
11784 name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (TYPE_NAME (type), 2);
11785 }
11786
11787 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
11788 if (!name && t != 0)
11789 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
11790 }
11791
11792 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
11793 }
11794
11795 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
11796 for bit field types. */
11797
11798 static inline tree
11799 member_declared_type (const_tree member)
11800 {
11801 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
11802 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
11803 }
11804
11805 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
11806 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
11807
11808 #if 0
11809 static const char *
11810 decl_start_label (tree decl)
11811 {
11812 rtx x;
11813 const char *fnname;
11814
11815 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
11816 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
11817
11818 x = XEXP (x, 0);
11819 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
11820
11821 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
11822 return fnname;
11823 }
11824 #endif
11825 \f
11826 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
11827 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
11828 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
11829
11830 static void
11831 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11832 {
11833 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
11834 dw_die_ref array_die;
11835 tree element_type;
11836
11837 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for array of array of enum types unless
11838 the inner array type comes before the outer array type. Thus we must
11839 call gen_type_die before we call new_die. See below also. */
11840 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11841 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11842 #endif
11843
11844 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
11845 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
11846 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
11847
11848 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
11849 {
11850 /* The frontend feeds us a representation for the vector as a struct
11851 containing an array. Pull out the array type. */
11852 type = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_FIELDS (TYPE_DEBUG_REPRESENTATION_TYPE (type)));
11853 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
11854 }
11855
11856 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
11857 if (is_fortran ()
11858 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
11859 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == ARRAY_TYPE)
11860 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
11861
11862 #if 0
11863 /* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
11864 the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
11865 an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
11866 SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
11867 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
11868 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
11869 for multidimensional arrays. */
11870 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
11871 #endif
11872
11873 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11874 /* The SGI compilers handle arrays of unknown bound by setting
11875 AT_declaration and not emitting any subrange DIEs. */
11876 if (! TYPE_DOMAIN (type))
11877 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11878 else
11879 #endif
11880 add_subscript_info (array_die, type);
11881
11882 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type. */
11883 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
11884
11885 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
11886 const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
11887 We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
11888 add_subscript_info. */
11889 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11890 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
11891 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
11892
11893 gen_type_die (element_type, context_die);
11894 #endif
11895
11896 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
11897
11898 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
11899 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
11900 }
11901
11902 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11903 descr_info_loc (tree val, tree base_decl)
11904 {
11905 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
11906 dw_loc_descr_ref loc, loc2;
11907 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
11908
11909 if (val == base_decl)
11910 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0);
11911
11912 switch (TREE_CODE (val))
11913 {
11914 case NOP_EXPR:
11915 case CONVERT_EXPR:
11916 return descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
11917 case INTEGER_CST:
11918 if (host_integerp (val, 0))
11919 return int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (val, 0));
11920 break;
11921 case INDIRECT_REF:
11922 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (val));
11923 if (size < 0)
11924 break;
11925 loc = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
11926 if (!loc)
11927 break;
11928 if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
11929 add_loc_descr (&loc, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
11930 else
11931 add_loc_descr (&loc, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref_size, size, 0));
11932 return loc;
11933 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
11934 case PLUS_EXPR:
11935 if (host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), 1)
11936 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), 1)
11937 < 16384)
11938 {
11939 loc = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
11940 if (!loc)
11941 break;
11942 add_loc_descr (&loc,
11943 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
11944 tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1),
11945 1), 0));
11946 }
11947 else
11948 {
11949 op = DW_OP_plus;
11950 do_binop:
11951 loc = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
11952 if (!loc)
11953 break;
11954 loc2 = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), base_decl);
11955 if (!loc2)
11956 break;
11957 add_loc_descr (&loc, loc2);
11958 add_loc_descr (&loc2, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
11959 }
11960 return loc;
11961 case MINUS_EXPR:
11962 op = DW_OP_minus;
11963 goto do_binop;
11964 case MULT_EXPR:
11965 op = DW_OP_mul;
11966 goto do_binop;
11967 case EQ_EXPR:
11968 op = DW_OP_eq;
11969 goto do_binop;
11970 case NE_EXPR:
11971 op = DW_OP_ne;
11972 goto do_binop;
11973 default:
11974 break;
11975 }
11976 return NULL;
11977 }
11978
11979 static void
11980 add_descr_info_field (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr,
11981 tree val, tree base_decl)
11982 {
11983 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
11984
11985 if (host_integerp (val, 0))
11986 {
11987 add_AT_unsigned (die, attr, tree_low_cst (val, 0));
11988 return;
11989 }
11990
11991 loc = descr_info_loc (val, base_decl);
11992 if (!loc)
11993 return;
11994
11995 add_AT_loc (die, attr, loc);
11996 }
11997
11998 /* This routine generates DIE for array with hidden descriptor, details
11999 are filled into *info by a langhook. */
12000
12001 static void
12002 gen_descr_array_type_die (tree type, struct array_descr_info *info,
12003 dw_die_ref context_die)
12004 {
12005 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
12006 dw_die_ref array_die;
12007 int dim;
12008
12009 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
12010 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
12011 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
12012
12013 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
12014 if (is_fortran ()
12015 && info->ndimensions >= 2)
12016 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
12017
12018 if (info->data_location)
12019 add_descr_info_field (array_die, DW_AT_data_location, info->data_location,
12020 info->base_decl);
12021 if (info->associated)
12022 add_descr_info_field (array_die, DW_AT_associated, info->associated,
12023 info->base_decl);
12024 if (info->allocated)
12025 add_descr_info_field (array_die, DW_AT_allocated, info->allocated,
12026 info->base_decl);
12027
12028 for (dim = 0; dim < info->ndimensions; dim++)
12029 {
12030 dw_die_ref subrange_die
12031 = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, array_die, NULL);
12032
12033 if (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound)
12034 {
12035 /* If it is the default value, omit it. */
12036 if ((is_c_family () || is_java ())
12037 && integer_zerop (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound))
12038 ;
12039 else if (is_fortran ()
12040 && integer_onep (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound))
12041 ;
12042 else
12043 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
12044 info->dimen[dim].lower_bound,
12045 info->base_decl);
12046 }
12047 if (info->dimen[dim].upper_bound)
12048 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
12049 info->dimen[dim].upper_bound,
12050 info->base_decl);
12051 if (info->dimen[dim].stride)
12052 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_stride,
12053 info->dimen[dim].stride,
12054 info->base_decl);
12055 }
12056
12057 gen_type_die (info->element_type, context_die);
12058 add_type_attribute (array_die, info->element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
12059
12060 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
12061 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
12062 }
12063
12064 #if 0
12065 static void
12066 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12067 {
12068 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12069 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
12070
12071 if (origin != NULL)
12072 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
12073 else
12074 {
12075 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
12076 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
12077 0, 0, context_die);
12078 }
12079
12080 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12081 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
12082 else
12083 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
12084 }
12085 #endif
12086
12087 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
12088 emit full debugging info for them. */
12089
12090 static void
12091 retry_incomplete_types (void)
12092 {
12093 int i;
12094
12095 for (i = VEC_length (tree, incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
12096 gen_type_die (VEC_index (tree, incomplete_types, i), comp_unit_die);
12097 }
12098
12099 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of an enumeration type. */
12100
12101 static void
12102 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12103 {
12104 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type, context_die, type);
12105
12106 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
12107 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
12108 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
12109 }
12110
12111 /* Determine what tag to use for a record type. */
12112
12113 static enum dwarf_tag
12114 record_type_tag (tree type)
12115 {
12116 if (! lang_hooks.types.classify_record)
12117 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
12118
12119 switch (lang_hooks.types.classify_record (type))
12120 {
12121 case RECORD_IS_STRUCT:
12122 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
12123
12124 case RECORD_IS_CLASS:
12125 return DW_TAG_class_type;
12126
12127 case RECORD_IS_INTERFACE:
12128 return DW_TAG_interface_type;
12129
12130 default:
12131 gcc_unreachable ();
12132 }
12133 }
12134
12135 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a structure type. */
12136
12137 static void
12138 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12139 {
12140 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (record_type_tag (type), context_die, type);
12141
12142 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
12143 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
12144 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
12145 }
12146
12147 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a union type. */
12148
12149 static void
12150 gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12151 {
12152 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_union_type, context_die, type);
12153
12154 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
12155 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
12156 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
12157 }
12158
12159 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
12160 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
12161 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
12162 DIE. */
12163
12164 static dw_die_ref
12165 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12166 {
12167 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12168
12169 if (type_die == NULL)
12170 {
12171 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
12172 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12173 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
12174 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
12175 }
12176 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
12177 return type_die;
12178 else
12179 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
12180
12181 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
12182 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
12183 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
12184 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
12185 {
12186 tree link;
12187
12188 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12189 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
12190 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
12191 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
12192
12193 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
12194 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
12195 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
12196 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
12197
12198 for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
12199 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
12200 {
12201 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
12202 tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
12203
12204 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
12205 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
12206
12207 if (host_integerp (value, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value))))
12208 /* DWARF2 does not provide a way of indicating whether or
12209 not enumeration constants are signed or unsigned. GDB
12210 always assumes the values are signed, so we output all
12211 values as if they were signed. That means that
12212 enumeration constants with very large unsigned values
12213 will appear to have negative values in the debugger. */
12214 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
12215 tree_low_cst (value, tree_int_cst_sgn (value) > 0));
12216 }
12217 }
12218 else
12219 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
12220
12221 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
12222 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
12223
12224 return type_die;
12225 }
12226
12227 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
12228 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
12229 type.
12230
12231 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
12232 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
12233 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
12234 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
12235 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
12236 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
12237 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
12238 argument type of some subprogram type. */
12239
12240 static dw_die_ref
12241 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, dw_die_ref context_die)
12242 {
12243 dw_die_ref parm_die
12244 = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
12245 tree origin;
12246
12247 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node)))
12248 {
12249 case tcc_declaration:
12250 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node);
12251 if (origin != NULL)
12252 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
12253 else
12254 {
12255 tree type = TREE_TYPE (node);
12256 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
12257 if (DECL_BY_REFERENCE (node))
12258 type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12259 add_type_attribute (parm_die, type,
12260 TREE_READONLY (node),
12261 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (node),
12262 context_die);
12263 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
12264 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
12265 }
12266
12267 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
12268 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node))
12269 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node, DW_AT_location);
12270
12271 break;
12272
12273 case tcc_type:
12274 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
12275 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node, 0, 0, context_die);
12276 break;
12277
12278 default:
12279 gcc_unreachable ();
12280 }
12281
12282 return parm_die;
12283 }
12284
12285 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
12286 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
12287
12288 static void
12289 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12290 {
12291 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
12292 }
12293
12294 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
12295 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
12296 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
12297 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
12298
12299 static void
12300 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12301 {
12302 tree link;
12303 tree formal_type = NULL;
12304 tree first_parm_type;
12305 tree arg;
12306
12307 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
12308 {
12309 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
12310 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
12311 }
12312 else
12313 arg = NULL_TREE;
12314
12315 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
12316
12317 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
12318 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
12319 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
12320 {
12321 dw_die_ref parm_die;
12322
12323 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
12324 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
12325 break;
12326
12327 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
12328 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, context_die);
12329 if ((TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
12330 && link == first_parm_type)
12331 || (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg)))
12332 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
12333
12334 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
12335 if (arg)
12336 arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg);
12337 }
12338
12339 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
12340 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
12341 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
12342 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
12343
12344 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
12345 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
12346 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
12347 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
12348 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
12349 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
12350 }
12351
12352 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
12353 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
12354 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
12355 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
12356 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
12357
12358 static void
12359 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
12360 {
12361 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
12362
12363 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
12364 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
12365 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
12366 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
12367 {
12368 dw_die_ref type_die;
12369 gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
12370
12371 push_decl_scope (type);
12372 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12373 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
12374 gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
12375 else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
12376 {
12377 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
12378 C++ anonymous unions and structs. */
12379 if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
12380 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
12381 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
12382 {
12383 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
12384 gen_field_die (member, type_die);
12385 }
12386 }
12387 else
12388 gen_variable_die (member, type_die);
12389
12390 pop_decl_scope ();
12391 }
12392 }
12393
12394 /* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
12395 may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of. */
12396
12397 static void
12398 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
12399 {
12400 dw_die_ref old_die;
12401 tree save_fn;
12402 tree context;
12403 int was_abstract = DECL_ABSTRACT (decl);
12404
12405 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
12406 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
12407
12408 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12409 if (old_die && get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
12410 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
12411 return;
12412
12413 /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
12414 we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT. */
12415 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12416 {
12417 context = decl_class_context (decl);
12418 if (context)
12419 gen_type_die_for_member
12420 (context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die);
12421 }
12422
12423 /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function. */
12424 save_fn = current_function_decl;
12425 current_function_decl = decl;
12426 push_cfun (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl));
12427
12428 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 1);
12429 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
12430 if (! was_abstract)
12431 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 0);
12432
12433 current_function_decl = save_fn;
12434 pop_cfun ();
12435 }
12436
12437 /* Helper function of premark_used_types() which gets called through
12438 htab_traverse_resize().
12439
12440 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
12441 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. */
12442 static int
12443 premark_used_types_helper (void **slot, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12444 {
12445 tree type;
12446 dw_die_ref die;
12447
12448 type = *slot;
12449 die = lookup_type_die (type);
12450 if (die != NULL)
12451 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
12452 return 1;
12453 }
12454
12455 /* Mark all members of used_types_hash as perennial. */
12456 static void
12457 premark_used_types (void)
12458 {
12459 if (cfun && cfun->used_types_hash)
12460 htab_traverse (cfun->used_types_hash, premark_used_types_helper, NULL);
12461 }
12462
12463 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
12464 block-local). */
12465
12466 static void
12467 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12468 {
12469 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12470 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12471 dw_die_ref subr_die;
12472 tree fn_arg_types;
12473 tree outer_scope;
12474 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12475 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
12476 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
12477
12478 premark_used_types ();
12479
12480 /* It is possible to have both DECL_ABSTRACT and DECLARATION be true if we
12481 started to generate the abstract instance of an inline, decided to output
12482 its containing class, and proceeded to emit the declaration of the inline
12483 from the member list for the class. If so, DECLARATION takes priority;
12484 we'll get back to the abstract instance when done with the class. */
12485
12486 /* The class-scope declaration DIE must be the primary DIE. */
12487 if (origin && declaration && class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die))
12488 {
12489 origin = NULL;
12490 gcc_assert (!old_die);
12491 }
12492
12493 /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
12494 might need to retrofit the declaration into its class. */
12495 if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
12496 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
12497 && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
12498 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12499 old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
12500
12501 if (origin != NULL)
12502 {
12503 gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
12504
12505 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
12506 inline function. */
12507 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
12508 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
12509
12510 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
12511 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
12512 }
12513 else if (old_die)
12514 {
12515 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
12516 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
12517
12518 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
12519 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
12520 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
12521 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
12522 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
12523 {
12524 /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
12525 something we have already output. */
12526 return;
12527 }
12528
12529 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
12530 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
12531 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
12532 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
12533 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
12534 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
12535 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
12536 if ((old_die->die_parent == comp_unit_die || context_die == NULL)
12537 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
12538 || (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
12539 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
12540 == (unsigned) s.line))))
12541 {
12542 subr_die = old_die;
12543
12544 /* Clear out the declaration attribute and the formal parameters.
12545 Do not remove all children, because it is possible that this
12546 declaration die was forced using force_decl_die(). In such
12547 cases die that forced declaration die (e.g. TAG_imported_module)
12548 is one of the children that we do not want to remove. */
12549 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration);
12550 remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
12551 }
12552 else
12553 {
12554 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
12555 add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
12556 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
12557 add_AT_file (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
12558 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
12559 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
12560 }
12561 }
12562 else
12563 {
12564 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
12565
12566 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
12567 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
12568
12569 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
12570 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12571 {
12572 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
12573 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
12574 0, 0, context_die);
12575 }
12576
12577 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
12578 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
12579 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
12580
12581 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
12582 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12583 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
12584 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
12585 }
12586
12587 if (declaration)
12588 {
12589 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
12590 {
12591 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
12592
12593 /* The first time we see a member function, it is in the context of
12594 the class to which it belongs. We make sure of this by emitting
12595 the class first. The next time is the definition, which is
12596 handled above. The two may come from the same source text.
12597
12598 Note that force_decl_die() forces function declaration die. It is
12599 later reused to represent definition. */
12600 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
12601 }
12602 }
12603 else if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12604 {
12605 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
12606 {
12607 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
12608 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
12609 else
12610 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
12611 }
12612 else
12613 {
12614 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
12615 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
12616 else
12617 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
12618 }
12619
12620 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl)
12621 && lookup_attribute ("artificial", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl)))
12622 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
12623
12624 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
12625 }
12626 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
12627 {
12628 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
12629
12630 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
12631 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
12632
12633 if (!flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
12634 {
12635 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
12636 current_function_funcdef_no);
12637 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label_id);
12638 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
12639 current_function_funcdef_no);
12640 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label_id);
12641
12642 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
12643 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
12644 }
12645 else
12646 { /* Do nothing for now; maybe need to duplicate die, one for
12647 hot section and ond for cold section, then use the hot/cold
12648 section begin/end labels to generate the aranges... */
12649 /*
12650 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, hot_section_label);
12651 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, hot_section_end_label);
12652 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_lo_user, unlikely_section_label);
12653 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_hi_user, cold_section_end_label);
12654
12655 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
12656 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
12657 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
12658 */
12659 }
12660
12661 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
12662 /* Add a reference to the FDE for this routine. */
12663 add_AT_fde_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_fde, current_funcdef_fde);
12664 #endif
12665
12666 cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
12667
12668 /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA. This is more
12669 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
12670 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
12671 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
12672 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
12673 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
12674 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
12675 function. */
12676 /* ??? Use some command-line or configury switch to enable the use
12677 of dwarf3 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. At present there are no dwarf
12678 consumers that understand it; fall back to "pure" dwarf2 and
12679 convert the CFA data into a location list. */
12680 {
12681 dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
12682 if (list->dw_loc_next)
12683 add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
12684 else
12685 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
12686 }
12687
12688 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
12689 the CFA. The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
12690 will reference in the rtl; the later is what we've told the
12691 debugger about. We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
12692 by this displacement. */
12693 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
12694
12695 if (cfun->static_chain_decl)
12696 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
12697 loc_descriptor_from_tree (cfun->static_chain_decl));
12698 }
12699
12700 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
12701 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
12702 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
12703 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
12704 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
12705 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
12706 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
12707 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
12708 an ellipsis at the end. */
12709
12710 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
12711 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
12712 its formal parameters. */
12713 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12714 ;
12715 else if (declaration)
12716 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
12717 else
12718 {
12719 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters. */
12720 tree arg_decls = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
12721 tree parm;
12722
12723 /* When generating DIEs, generate the unspecified_parameters DIE
12724 instead if we come across the arg "__builtin_va_alist" */
12725 for (parm = arg_decls; parm; parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm))
12726 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
12727 {
12728 if (DECL_NAME (parm)
12729 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm)),
12730 "__builtin_va_alist"))
12731 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (parm, subr_die);
12732 else
12733 gen_decl_die (parm, subr_die);
12734 }
12735
12736 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
12737 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
12738 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
12739 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
12740 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
12741 parameters at all. */
12742 fn_arg_types = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl));
12743 if (fn_arg_types != NULL)
12744 {
12745 /* This is the prototyped case, check for.... */
12746 if (TREE_VALUE (tree_last (fn_arg_types)) != void_type_node)
12747 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
12748 }
12749 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
12750 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
12751 }
12752
12753 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
12754 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration). */
12755 outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
12756
12757 /* OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
12758 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
12759 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
12760 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
12761 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
12762 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
12763 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
12764
12765 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
12766 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
12767 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
12768 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
12769 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
12770 constructor function. */
12771 if (! declaration && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
12772 {
12773 /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value. */
12774 if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
12775 gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), subr_die);
12776
12777 current_function_has_inlines = 0;
12778 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die, 0);
12779
12780 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
12781 if (current_function_has_inlines)
12782 {
12783 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
12784 if (! comp_unit_has_inlines)
12785 {
12786 add_AT_flag (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
12787 comp_unit_has_inlines = 1;
12788 }
12789 }
12790 #endif
12791 }
12792 /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested. */
12793 add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, decl);
12794
12795 }
12796
12797 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object. */
12798
12799 static void
12800 gen_variable_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12801 {
12802 HOST_WIDE_INT off;
12803 rtx csym;
12804 dw_die_ref var_die;
12805 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12806 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12807 int declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
12808 /* If DECL is COMDAT and has not actually been
12809 emitted, we cannot take its address; there
12810 might end up being no definition anywhere in
12811 the program. For example, consider the C++
12812 test case:
12813
12814 template <class T>
12815 struct S { static const int i = 7; };
12816
12817 template <class T>
12818 const int S<T>::i;
12819
12820 int f() { return S<int>::i; }
12821
12822 Here, S<int>::i is not DECL_EXTERNAL, but no
12823 definition is required, so the compiler will
12824 not emit a definition. */
12825 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
12826 && DECL_COMDAT (decl) && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
12827 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
12828
12829 csym = common_check (decl, &off);
12830
12831 /* Symbol in common gets emitted as a child of the common block, in the form
12832 of a data member.
12833
12834 ??? This creates a new common block die for every common block symbol.
12835 Better to share same common block die for all symbols in that block. */
12836 if (csym)
12837 {
12838 tree blok;
12839 dw_die_ref com_die;
12840 const char *cnam = targetm.strip_name_encoding(XSTR (csym, 0));
12841 dw_loc_descr_ref loc = mem_loc_descriptor (csym, dw_val_class_addr,
12842 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12843
12844 blok = (tree) TREE_OPERAND (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (decl), 0);
12845 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_common_block, context_die, decl);
12846 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, blok);
12847 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
12848 add_AT_loc (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
12849 com_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, var_die, decl);
12850 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (com_die, decl);
12851 add_type_attribute (com_die, TREE_TYPE (decl), TREE_READONLY (decl),
12852 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
12853 add_AT_loc (com_die, DW_AT_data_member_location, int_loc_descriptor(off));
12854 add_pubname_string (cnam, var_die); /* ??? needed? */
12855 return;
12856 }
12857
12858 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
12859
12860 if (origin != NULL)
12861 add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
12862
12863 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
12864 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
12865
12866 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
12867 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT flag on them instead of
12868 sharing them.
12869
12870 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges.
12871
12872 ??? The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
12873 variable, both of which are declarations. We want to avoid considering
12874 one to be a specification, so we must test that this DIE is not a
12875 declaration. */
12876 else if (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && ! declaration
12877 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1)
12878 {
12879 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
12880 add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
12881 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
12882 {
12883 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
12884 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
12885
12886 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
12887 add_AT_file (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
12888
12889 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
12890 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
12891 }
12892 }
12893 else
12894 {
12895 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
12896 if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
12897 || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL)
12898 && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl))
12899 type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12900
12901 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
12902 add_type_attribute (var_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
12903 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
12904
12905 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
12906 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
12907
12908 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
12909 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
12910
12911 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
12912 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12913 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
12914 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
12915 }
12916
12917 if (declaration)
12918 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
12919
12920 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) || declaration)
12921 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
12922
12923 if (! declaration && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12924 {
12925 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl, DW_AT_location);
12926 add_pubname (decl, var_die);
12927 }
12928 else
12929 tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl);
12930 }
12931
12932 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
12933
12934 static void
12935 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12936 {
12937 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12938 dw_die_ref lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
12939 rtx insn;
12940 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12941
12942 if (origin != NULL)
12943 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
12944 else
12945 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
12946
12947 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12948 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
12949 else
12950 {
12951 insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
12952
12953 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
12954 eliminated because of various optimizations. We still emit them
12955 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
12956 if (insn
12957 && (LABEL_P (insn)
12958 || ((NOTE_P (insn)
12959 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
12960 {
12961 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
12962 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
12963 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
12964 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
12965 it if it ever does happen. */
12966 gcc_assert (!INSN_DELETED_P (insn));
12967
12968 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
12969 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
12970 }
12971 }
12972 }
12973
12974 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die. Add source coordinate
12975 attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
12976 function was called from. This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes. */
12977
12978 static inline void
12979 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
12980 {
12981 expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
12982
12983 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_call_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
12984 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
12985 }
12986
12987
12988 /* If STMT's abstract origin is a function declaration and STMT's
12989 first subblock's abstract origin is the function's outermost block,
12990 then we're looking at the main entry point. */
12991 static bool
12992 is_inlined_entry_point (const_tree stmt)
12993 {
12994 tree decl, block;
12995
12996 if (!stmt || TREE_CODE (stmt) != BLOCK)
12997 return false;
12998
12999 decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
13000
13001 if (!decl || TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL)
13002 return false;
13003
13004 block = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
13005
13006 if (block)
13007 {
13008 if (TREE_CODE (block) != BLOCK)
13009 return false;
13010
13011 block = block_ultimate_origin (block);
13012 }
13013
13014 return block == DECL_INITIAL (decl);
13015 }
13016
13017 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
13018 Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT. */
13019
13020 static inline void
13021 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
13022 {
13023 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
13024
13025 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt))
13026 {
13027 tree chain;
13028
13029 if (is_inlined_entry_point (stmt))
13030 {
13031 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
13032 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
13033 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
13034 }
13035
13036 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt));
13037
13038 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
13039 do
13040 {
13041 add_ranges (chain);
13042 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
13043 }
13044 while (chain);
13045 add_ranges (NULL);
13046 }
13047 else
13048 {
13049 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
13050 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
13051 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
13052 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
13053 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
13054 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
13055 }
13056 }
13057
13058 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
13059
13060 static void
13061 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
13062 {
13063 dw_die_ref stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
13064
13065 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
13066 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
13067
13068 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die, depth);
13069 }
13070
13071 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
13072
13073 static void
13074 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
13075 {
13076 tree decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
13077
13078 /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet. We
13079 must emit this even if the block is abstract, otherwise when we
13080 emit the block below (or elsewhere), we may end up trying to emit
13081 a die whose origin die hasn't been emitted, and crashing. */
13082 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
13083
13084 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
13085 {
13086 dw_die_ref subr_die
13087 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
13088
13089 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
13090 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
13091 add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
13092
13093 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die, depth);
13094 current_function_has_inlines = 1;
13095 }
13096 else
13097 /* We may get here if we're the outer block of function A that was
13098 inlined into function B that was inlined into function C. When
13099 generating debugging info for C, dwarf2out_abstract_function(B)
13100 would mark all inlined blocks as abstract, including this one.
13101 So, we wouldn't (and shouldn't) expect labels to be generated
13102 for this one. Instead, just emit debugging info for
13103 declarations within the block. This is particularly important
13104 in the case of initializers of arguments passed from B to us:
13105 if they're statement expressions containing declarations, we
13106 wouldn't generate dies for their abstract variables, and then,
13107 when generating dies for the real variables, we'd die (pun
13108 intended :-) */
13109 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
13110 }
13111
13112 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. */
13113
13114 static void
13115 gen_field_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
13116 {
13117 dw_die_ref decl_die;
13118
13119 if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
13120 return;
13121
13122 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
13123 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
13124 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl),
13125 TREE_READONLY (decl), TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl),
13126 context_die);
13127
13128 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
13129 {
13130 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
13131 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
13132 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl);
13133 }
13134
13135 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
13136 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl);
13137
13138 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
13139 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
13140
13141 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
13142 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
13143 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
13144 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
13145
13146 /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on. */
13147 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
13148 }
13149
13150 #if 0
13151 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
13152 Use modified_type_die instead.
13153 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
13154 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
13155
13156 static void
13157 gen_pointer_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
13158 {
13159 dw_die_ref ptr_die
13160 = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
13161
13162 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
13163 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
13164 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
13165 }
13166
13167 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
13168 Use modified_type_die instead.
13169 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
13170 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
13171
13172 static void
13173 gen_reference_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
13174 {
13175 dw_die_ref ref_die
13176 = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
13177
13178 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
13179 add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
13180 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
13181 }
13182 #endif
13183
13184 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. */
13185
13186 static void
13187 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
13188 {
13189 dw_die_ref ptr_die
13190 = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
13191 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
13192
13193 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
13194 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
13195 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
13196 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
13197 }
13198
13199 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
13200
13201 static dw_die_ref
13202 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
13203 {
13204 dw_die_ref die;
13205 char producer[250];
13206 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
13207 int language;
13208
13209 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
13210
13211 if (filename)
13212 {
13213 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
13214 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
13215 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename) && filename[0] != '<')
13216 add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
13217 }
13218
13219 sprintf (producer, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
13220
13221 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
13222 /* The MIPS/SGI compilers place the 'cc' command line options in the producer
13223 string. The SGI debugger looks for -g, -g1, -g2, or -g3; if they do
13224 not appear in the producer string, the debugger reaches the conclusion
13225 that the object file is stripped and has no debugging information.
13226 To get the MIPS/SGI debugger to believe that there is debugging
13227 information in the object file, we add a -g to the producer string. */
13228 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13229 strcat (producer, " -g");
13230 #endif
13231
13232 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer);
13233
13234 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++") == 0)
13235 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
13236 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
13237 language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
13238 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
13239 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
13240 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran") == 0)
13241 language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
13242 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
13243 language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
13244 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
13245 language = DW_LANG_Java;
13246 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C") == 0)
13247 language = DW_LANG_ObjC;
13248 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C++") == 0)
13249 language = DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
13250 else
13251 language = DW_LANG_C89;
13252
13253 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
13254 return die;
13255 }
13256
13257 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
13258
13259 static void
13260 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, dw_die_ref context_die)
13261 {
13262 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
13263
13264 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), 0, 0, context_die);
13265 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo);
13266
13267 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
13268 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
13269
13270 if (access == access_public_node)
13271 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
13272 else if (access == access_protected_node)
13273 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
13274 }
13275
13276 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
13277
13278 static void
13279 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
13280 {
13281 tree member;
13282 tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
13283 dw_die_ref child;
13284
13285 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
13286 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
13287 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
13288 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
13289 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
13290 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
13291 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
13292 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
13293 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
13294 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
13295 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
13296
13297 /* First output info about the base classes. */
13298 if (binfo)
13299 {
13300 VEC(tree,gc) *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
13301 int i;
13302 tree base;
13303
13304 for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
13305 gen_inheritance_die (base,
13306 (accesses ? VEC_index (tree, accesses, i)
13307 : access_public_node), context_die);
13308 }
13309
13310 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
13311 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
13312 {
13313 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
13314 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
13315 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
13316 do put them in the right order. */
13317
13318 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
13319 if (child)
13320 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
13321 else
13322 gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
13323 }
13324
13325 /* Now output info about the function members (if any). */
13326 for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
13327 {
13328 /* Don't include clones in the member list. */
13329 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
13330 continue;
13331
13332 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
13333 if (child)
13334 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
13335 else
13336 gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
13337 }
13338 }
13339
13340 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
13341 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
13342 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
13343
13344 static void
13345 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
13346 enum debug_info_usage usage)
13347 {
13348 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
13349 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
13350 int nested = 0;
13351 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
13352 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
13353 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
13354 int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
13355 complete = complete && should_emit_struct_debug (type, usage);
13356
13357 if (type_die && ! complete)
13358 return;
13359
13360 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
13361 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
13362 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
13363 nested = 1;
13364
13365 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
13366
13367 if (! type_die || (nested && scope_die == comp_unit_die))
13368 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
13369 {
13370 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
13371
13372 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
13373 ? record_type_tag (type) : DW_TAG_union_type,
13374 scope_die, type);
13375 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
13376 if (old_die)
13377 add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
13378 else
13379 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
13380 }
13381 else
13382 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
13383
13384 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
13385 then give a list of members. */
13386 if (complete && !ns_decl)
13387 {
13388 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
13389 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
13390 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
13391 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
13392 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
13393 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
13394
13395 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
13396 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
13397 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
13398 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
13399
13400 push_decl_scope (type);
13401 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
13402 pop_decl_scope ();
13403
13404 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
13405 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
13406 {
13407 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
13408
13409 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
13410 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
13411 lookup_type_die (vtype));
13412 }
13413 }
13414 else
13415 {
13416 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
13417
13418 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
13419 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
13420 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
13421 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, incomplete_types, type);
13422 }
13423
13424 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
13425 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
13426 }
13427
13428 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
13429
13430 static void
13431 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
13432 {
13433 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
13434 dw_die_ref subr_die
13435 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
13436 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
13437
13438 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
13439 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
13440 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, 0, 0, context_die);
13441 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
13442
13443 if (get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_name))
13444 add_pubtype (type, subr_die);
13445 }
13446
13447 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition. */
13448
13449 static void
13450 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
13451 {
13452 dw_die_ref type_die;
13453 tree origin;
13454
13455 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
13456 return;
13457
13458 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
13459 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
13460 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
13461 if (origin != NULL)
13462 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
13463 else
13464 {
13465 tree type;
13466
13467 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
13468 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
13469 {
13470 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
13471
13472 gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
13473 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
13474 }
13475 else
13476 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
13477
13478 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
13479 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
13480 }
13481
13482 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
13483 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
13484
13485 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
13486 add_pubtype (decl, type_die);
13487 }
13488
13489 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
13490
13491 static void
13492 gen_type_die_with_usage (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
13493 enum debug_info_usage usage)
13494 {
13495 int need_pop;
13496 struct array_descr_info info;
13497
13498 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
13499 return;
13500
13501 if (TYPE_NAME (type) && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
13502 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
13503 {
13504 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
13505 return;
13506
13507 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
13508 gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)) != type);
13509
13510 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
13511 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), context_die);
13512 return;
13513 }
13514
13515 /* If this is an array type with hidden descriptor, handle it first. */
13516 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type)
13517 && lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info
13518 && lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info (type, &info))
13519 {
13520 gen_descr_array_type_die (type, &info, context_die);
13521 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
13522 return;
13523 }
13524
13525 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
13526 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
13527 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
13528 now. (Vectors are special because the debugging info is in the
13529 cloned type itself). */
13530 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
13531 type = type_main_variant (type);
13532
13533 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
13534 return;
13535
13536 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
13537 {
13538 case ERROR_MARK:
13539 break;
13540
13541 case POINTER_TYPE:
13542 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
13543 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
13544 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
13545 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
13546 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
13547 statement. */
13548 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
13549
13550 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
13551 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
13552 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
13553 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
13554 break;
13555
13556 case OFFSET_TYPE:
13557 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
13558 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
13559 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die,
13560 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
13561
13562 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
13563 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
13564 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
13565
13566 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
13567 itself. */
13568 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
13569 break;
13570
13571 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
13572 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
13573 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
13574 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
13575 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
13576 break;
13577
13578 case METHOD_TYPE:
13579 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
13580 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
13581 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
13582 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
13583 break;
13584
13585 case ARRAY_TYPE:
13586 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
13587 break;
13588
13589 case VECTOR_TYPE:
13590 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
13591 break;
13592
13593 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
13594 case RECORD_TYPE:
13595 case UNION_TYPE:
13596 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
13597 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
13598 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
13599 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
13600 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
13601 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
13602 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
13603 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
13604 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
13605 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
13606 {
13607 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die, usage);
13608
13609 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
13610 return;
13611
13612 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
13613 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13614 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13615 need_pop = 1;
13616 }
13617 else
13618 {
13619 declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
13620 need_pop = 0;
13621 }
13622
13623 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
13624 {
13625 /* This might have been written out by the call to
13626 declare_in_namespace. */
13627 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
13628 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
13629 }
13630 else
13631 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
13632
13633 if (need_pop)
13634 pop_decl_scope ();
13635
13636 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
13637 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
13638 when appropriate. */
13639 return;
13640
13641 case VOID_TYPE:
13642 case INTEGER_TYPE:
13643 case REAL_TYPE:
13644 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
13645 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
13646 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
13647 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
13648 break;
13649
13650 case LANG_TYPE:
13651 /* No Dwarf representation currently defined. */
13652 break;
13653
13654 default:
13655 gcc_unreachable ();
13656 }
13657
13658 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
13659 }
13660
13661 static void
13662 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
13663 {
13664 gen_type_die_with_usage (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
13665 }
13666
13667 /* Generate a DIE for a tagged type instantiation. */
13668
13669 static void
13670 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
13671 {
13672 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
13673 return;
13674
13675 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version of
13676 this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so make sure
13677 that we have the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this
13678 type now. */
13679 gcc_assert (type == type_main_variant (type));
13680
13681 /* Do not check TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) as it may not be set if this is
13682 an instance of an unresolved type. */
13683
13684 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
13685 {
13686 case ERROR_MARK:
13687 break;
13688
13689 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
13690 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
13691 break;
13692
13693 case RECORD_TYPE:
13694 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (type, context_die);
13695 break;
13696
13697 case UNION_TYPE:
13698 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
13699 gen_inlined_union_type_die (type, context_die);
13700 break;
13701
13702 default:
13703 gcc_unreachable ();
13704 }
13705 }
13706
13707 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
13708 things which are local to the given block. */
13709
13710 static void
13711 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
13712 {
13713 int must_output_die = 0;
13714 tree origin;
13715 tree decl;
13716 enum tree_code origin_code;
13717
13718 /* Ignore blocks that are NULL. */
13719 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
13720 return;
13721
13722 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
13723 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
13724 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
13725 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
13726 {
13727 tree sub;
13728
13729 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
13730 gen_block_die (sub, context_die, depth + 1);
13731
13732 return;
13733 }
13734
13735 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of this block. This block may be an
13736 inlined instance of an inlined instance of inline function, so we have
13737 to trace all of the way back through the origin chain to find out what
13738 sort of node actually served as the original seed for the creation of
13739 the current block. */
13740 origin = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
13741 origin_code = (origin != NULL) ? TREE_CODE (origin) : ERROR_MARK;
13742
13743 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
13744 block. */
13745 if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
13746 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
13747 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
13748 must_output_die = 1;
13749 else
13750 {
13751 /* In the case where the current block represents an inlining of the
13752 "body block" of an inline function, we must *NOT* output any DIE for
13753 this block because we have already output a DIE to represent the whole
13754 inlined function scope and the "body block" of any function doesn't
13755 really represent a different scope according to ANSI C rules. So we
13756 check here to make sure that this block does not represent a "body
13757 block inlining" before trying to set the MUST_OUTPUT_DIE flag. */
13758 if (! is_body_block (origin ? origin : stmt))
13759 {
13760 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
13761 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
13762 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13763 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
13764 as being a "significant" one. */
13765 must_output_die = (BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
13766 && (TREE_USED (stmt)
13767 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
13768 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
13769 else
13770 /* We are in terse mode, so only local (nested) function
13771 definitions count as "significant" local declarations. */
13772 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
13773 decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
13774 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
13775 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
13776 {
13777 must_output_die = 1;
13778 break;
13779 }
13780 }
13781 }
13782
13783 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
13784 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
13785 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
13786 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
13787 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
13788 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
13789 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
13790 if (must_output_die)
13791 {
13792 if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
13793 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
13794 else
13795 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
13796 }
13797 else
13798 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth);
13799 }
13800
13801 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
13802 all of its sub-blocks. */
13803
13804 static void
13805 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
13806 {
13807 tree decl;
13808 tree subblocks;
13809
13810 /* Ignore NULL blocks. */
13811 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
13812 return;
13813
13814 if (TREE_USED (stmt))
13815 {
13816 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
13817 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
13818 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
13819 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. */
13820 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
13821 {
13822 dw_die_ref die;
13823
13824 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
13825 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13826 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
13827 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
13828 else
13829 die = NULL;
13830
13831 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
13832 add_child_die (context_die, die);
13833 /* Do not produce debug information for static variables since
13834 these might be optimized out. We are called for these later
13835 in varpool_analyze_pending_decls.
13836
13837 But *do* produce it for Fortran COMMON variables because,
13838 even though they are static, their names can differ depending
13839 on the scope, which we need to preserve. */
13840 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && TREE_STATIC (decl)
13841 && !(is_fortran () && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)))
13842 ;
13843 else
13844 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
13845 }
13846 }
13847
13848 /* If we're at -g1, we're not interested in subblocks. */
13849 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13850 return;
13851
13852 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
13853 therein) of this block. */
13854 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
13855 subblocks != NULL;
13856 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
13857 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die, depth + 1);
13858 }
13859
13860 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
13861
13862 static inline int
13863 is_redundant_typedef (const_tree decl)
13864 {
13865 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
13866 return 1;
13867
13868 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
13869 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
13870 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
13871 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
13872 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
13873 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
13874 return 1;
13875
13876 return 0;
13877 }
13878
13879 /* Returns the DIE for decl. A DIE will always be returned. */
13880
13881 static dw_die_ref
13882 force_decl_die (tree decl)
13883 {
13884 dw_die_ref decl_die;
13885 unsigned saved_external_flag;
13886 tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
13887 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13888 if (!decl_die)
13889 {
13890 dw_die_ref context_die;
13891 tree decl_context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
13892 if (decl_context)
13893 {
13894 /* Find die that represents this context. */
13895 if (TYPE_P (decl_context))
13896 context_die = force_type_die (decl_context);
13897 else
13898 context_die = force_decl_die (decl_context);
13899 }
13900 else
13901 context_die = comp_unit_die;
13902
13903 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13904 if (decl_die)
13905 return decl_die;
13906
13907 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
13908 {
13909 case FUNCTION_DECL:
13910 /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
13911 that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
13912 declaration die. */
13913 save_fn = current_function_decl;
13914 current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
13915 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
13916 current_function_decl = save_fn;
13917 break;
13918
13919 case VAR_DECL:
13920 /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
13921 gen_decl_die() call. */
13922 saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
13923 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
13924 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
13925 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
13926 break;
13927
13928 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13929 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
13930 break;
13931
13932 default:
13933 gcc_unreachable ();
13934 }
13935
13936 /* We should be able to find the DIE now. */
13937 if (!decl_die)
13938 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13939 gcc_assert (decl_die);
13940 }
13941
13942 return decl_die;
13943 }
13944
13945 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE, that must not be a base type. A DIE is
13946 always returned. */
13947
13948 static dw_die_ref
13949 force_type_die (tree type)
13950 {
13951 dw_die_ref type_die;
13952
13953 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
13954 if (!type_die)
13955 {
13956 dw_die_ref context_die;
13957 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
13958 {
13959 if (TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
13960 context_die = force_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13961 else
13962 context_die = force_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13963 }
13964 else
13965 context_die = comp_unit_die;
13966
13967 type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_READONLY (type),
13968 TYPE_VOLATILE (type), context_die);
13969 gcc_assert (type_die);
13970 }
13971 return type_die;
13972 }
13973
13974 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
13975 and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed. */
13976
13977 static dw_die_ref
13978 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
13979 {
13980 tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
13981 ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
13982 if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
13983 /* Force out the namespace. */
13984 context_die = force_decl_die (context);
13985
13986 return context_die;
13987 }
13988
13989 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
13990 type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
13991
13992 For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
13993 declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope. */
13994
13995 static void
13996 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
13997 {
13998 dw_die_ref ns_context;
13999
14000 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
14001 return;
14002
14003 /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
14004 namespace, as we will get confused. It would have already been emitted
14005 when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways. */
14006 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
14007 return;
14008
14009 ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
14010
14011 if (ns_context != context_die)
14012 {
14013 if (DECL_P (thing))
14014 gen_decl_die (thing, ns_context);
14015 else
14016 gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
14017 }
14018 }
14019
14020 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias. */
14021
14022 static void
14023 gen_namespace_die (tree decl)
14024 {
14025 dw_die_ref context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die);
14026
14027 /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
14028 they are an alias of. */
14029 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
14030 {
14031 /* Output a real namespace. */
14032 dw_die_ref namespace_die
14033 = new_die (DW_TAG_namespace, context_die, decl);
14034 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
14035 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
14036 }
14037 else
14038 {
14039 /* Output a namespace alias. */
14040
14041 /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary. */
14042 dw_die_ref origin_die
14043 = force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
14044
14045 /* Now create the namespace alias DIE. */
14046 dw_die_ref namespace_die
14047 = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
14048 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
14049 add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
14050 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
14051 }
14052 }
14053
14054 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL. */
14055
14056 static void
14057 gen_decl_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
14058 {
14059 tree origin;
14060
14061 if (DECL_P (decl) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
14062 return;
14063
14064 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
14065 {
14066 case ERROR_MARK:
14067 break;
14068
14069 case CONST_DECL:
14070 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
14071 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
14072 break;
14073
14074 case FUNCTION_DECL:
14075 /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
14076 unless they are class members or explicit block externs. */
14077 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) == NULL_TREE
14078 && (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)))
14079 break;
14080
14081 #if 0
14082 /* FIXME */
14083 /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
14084 on local redeclarations of global functions. That seems broken. */
14085 if (current_function_decl != decl)
14086 /* This is only a declaration. */;
14087 #endif
14088
14089 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
14090 if (DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
14091 dwarf2out_abstract_function (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
14092
14093 /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
14094 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it. */
14095 else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
14096 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
14097 && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
14098 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
14099 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
14100 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
14101 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
14102 {
14103 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
14104 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
14105 }
14106
14107 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
14108 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
14109 {
14110 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
14111 have described its return type. */
14112 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
14113
14114 /* And its virtual context. */
14115 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
14116 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
14117
14118 /* And its containing type. */
14119 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
14120 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
14121 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
14122
14123 /* And its containing namespace. */
14124 declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
14125 }
14126
14127 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
14128 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
14129 break;
14130
14131 case TYPE_DECL:
14132 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
14133 actual typedefs. */
14134 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
14135 break;
14136
14137 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
14138 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
14139 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
14140 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
14141 have to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
14142 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. */
14143 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE
14144 && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
14145 {
14146 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
14147 break;
14148 }
14149
14150 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
14151 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
14152 else
14153 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
14154 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
14155 break;
14156
14157 case LABEL_DECL:
14158 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
14159 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
14160 break;
14161
14162 case VAR_DECL:
14163 case RESULT_DECL:
14164 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
14165 variable declarations or definitions. */
14166 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
14167 break;
14168
14169 /* If this is the global definition of the Fortran COMMON block, we don't
14170 need to do anything. Syntactically, the block itself has no identity,
14171 just its constituent identifiers. */
14172 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
14173 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
14174 && TREE_STATIC (decl)
14175 && is_fortran ()
14176 && !DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (decl))
14177 break;
14178
14179 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
14180 object. */
14181 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl))
14182 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
14183 else
14184 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
14185
14186 /* And its containing type. */
14187 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
14188 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
14189 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
14190
14191 /* And its containing namespace. */
14192 declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
14193
14194 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
14195 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
14196 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
14197 function. */
14198 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
14199 if (origin != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (origin) == PARM_DECL)
14200 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
14201 else
14202 gen_variable_die (decl, context_die);
14203 break;
14204
14205 case FIELD_DECL:
14206 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
14207 anonymous unions and structs. */
14208 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
14209 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
14210 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
14211 {
14212 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
14213 gen_field_die (decl, context_die);
14214 }
14215 break;
14216
14217 case PARM_DECL:
14218 if (DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl))
14219 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
14220 else
14221 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
14222 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
14223 break;
14224
14225 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
14226 gen_namespace_die (decl);
14227 break;
14228
14229 default:
14230 /* Probably some frontend-internal decl. Assume we don't care. */
14231 gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
14232 break;
14233 }
14234 }
14235 \f
14236 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from toplev.c after
14237 compilation proper has finished. */
14238
14239 static void
14240 dwarf2out_global_decl (tree decl)
14241 {
14242 /* Output DWARF2 information for file-scope tentative data object
14243 declarations, file-scope (extern) function declarations (which had no
14244 corresponding body) and file-scope tagged type declarations and
14245 definitions which have not yet been forced out.
14246
14247 Ignore the global decl of any Fortran COMMON blocks which also wind up here
14248 though they have already been described in the local scope for the
14249 procedures using them. */
14250 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
14251 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl) && TREE_STATIC (decl) && is_fortran ())
14252 return;
14253
14254 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || !DECL_INITIAL (decl))
14255 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
14256 }
14257
14258 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL. Called from toplev.c
14259 and from language front ends (to record built-in types). */
14260 static void
14261 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
14262 {
14263 if (!local)
14264 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
14265 }
14266
14267 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl. */
14268
14269 static void
14270 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree context)
14271 {
14272 dw_die_ref imported_die, at_import_die;
14273 dw_die_ref scope_die;
14274 expanded_location xloc;
14275
14276 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
14277 return;
14278
14279 gcc_assert (decl);
14280
14281 /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
14282 We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
14283 itself. */
14284
14285 /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
14286 or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die. */
14287 if (!context)
14288 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
14289 else if (TYPE_P (context))
14290 {
14291 if (!should_emit_struct_debug (context, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
14292 return;
14293 scope_die = force_type_die (context);
14294 }
14295 else
14296 scope_die = force_decl_die (context);
14297
14298 /* For TYPE_DECL or CONST_DECL, lookup TREE_TYPE. */
14299 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
14300 {
14301 if (is_base_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
14302 at_import_die = base_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
14303 else
14304 at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
14305 }
14306 else
14307 {
14308 at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
14309 if (!at_import_die)
14310 {
14311 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
14312 emitted the member decl for this field. Emit it now. */
14313 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
14314 {
14315 tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
14316 dw_die_ref type_context_die;
14317
14318 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
14319 if (TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
14320 {
14321 if (!should_emit_struct_debug (TYPE_CONTEXT (type),
14322 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
14323 return;
14324 type_context_die = force_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
14325 }
14326 else
14327 type_context_die = force_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
14328 else
14329 type_context_die = comp_unit_die;
14330 gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl, type_context_die);
14331 }
14332 at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
14333 }
14334 }
14335
14336 /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die. */
14337 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
14338 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module, scope_die, context);
14339 else
14340 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, scope_die, context);
14341
14342 xloc = expand_location (input_location);
14343 add_AT_file (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (xloc.file));
14344 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
14345 add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
14346 }
14347
14348 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
14349
14350 void
14351 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
14352 {
14353 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die;
14354
14355 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
14356 {
14357 case ERROR_MARK:
14358 return;
14359
14360 case FUNCTION_DECL:
14361 /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
14362 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
14363 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
14364 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
14365 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
14366 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
14367 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions. If
14368 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
14369 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
14370 with the definition of the function.
14371
14372 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
14373 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
14374 declarations. We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
14375 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
14376 function definitions. These can get inlined within the current
14377 translation unit (and thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
14378 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
14379 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
14380 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
14381 that they *are* definitions).
14382
14383 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
14384 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
14385 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
14386 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
14387 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas. */
14388 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
14389 return;
14390
14391 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
14392 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
14393 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
14394 if (decl_function_context (decl)
14395 /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
14396 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
14397 context_die = NULL;
14398 break;
14399
14400 case VAR_DECL:
14401 /* Ignore this VAR_DECL if it refers to a file-scope extern data object
14402 declaration and if the declaration was never even referenced from
14403 within this entire compilation unit. We suppress these DIEs in
14404 order to save space in the .debug section (by eliminating entries
14405 which are probably useless). Note that we must not suppress
14406 block-local extern declarations (whether used or not) because that
14407 would screw-up the debugger's name lookup mechanism and cause it to
14408 miss things which really ought to be in scope at a given point. */
14409 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !TREE_USED (decl))
14410 return;
14411
14412 /* For local statics lookup proper context die. */
14413 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
14414 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
14415
14416 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
14417 variable declarations or definitions. */
14418 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
14419 return;
14420 break;
14421
14422 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
14423 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
14424 return;
14425 if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
14426 return;
14427 break;
14428
14429 case TYPE_DECL:
14430 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
14431 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
14432 return;
14433
14434 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
14435 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
14436 if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
14437 {
14438 /* OK, we need to generate one for `bool' so GDB knows what type
14439 comparisons have. */
14440 if (is_cxx ()
14441 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == BOOLEAN_TYPE
14442 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
14443 modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), 0, 0, NULL);
14444
14445 return;
14446 }
14447
14448 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
14449 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
14450 return;
14451
14452 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
14453 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
14454 if (decl_function_context (decl))
14455 context_die = NULL;
14456
14457 break;
14458
14459 default:
14460 return;
14461 }
14462
14463 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
14464 }
14465
14466 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
14467 a lexical block. */
14468
14469 static void
14470 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
14471 unsigned int blocknum)
14472 {
14473 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
14474 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
14475 }
14476
14477 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
14478 lexical block. */
14479
14480 static void
14481 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
14482 {
14483 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
14484 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
14485 }
14486
14487 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
14488 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
14489
14490 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
14491 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
14492 we may end up calling them anyway. */
14493
14494 static bool
14495 dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree block)
14496 {
14497 tree decl;
14498
14499 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
14500 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
14501 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
14502 return 0;
14503
14504 return 1;
14505 }
14506
14507 /* Hash table routines for file_hash. */
14508
14509 static int
14510 file_table_eq (const void *p1_p, const void *p2_p)
14511 {
14512 const struct dwarf_file_data * p1 = p1_p;
14513 const char * p2 = p2_p;
14514 return strcmp (p1->filename, p2) == 0;
14515 }
14516
14517 static hashval_t
14518 file_table_hash (const void *p_p)
14519 {
14520 const struct dwarf_file_data * p = p_p;
14521 return htab_hash_string (p->filename);
14522 }
14523
14524 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
14525 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
14526 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
14527 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
14528 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
14529 and.debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
14530 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
14531 available unique index number. In order to speed up searches, we remember
14532 the index of the filename was looked up last. This handles the majority of
14533 all searches. */
14534
14535 static struct dwarf_file_data *
14536 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
14537 {
14538 void ** slot;
14539 struct dwarf_file_data * created;
14540
14541 /* Check to see if the file name that was searched on the previous
14542 call matches this file name. If so, return the index. */
14543 if (file_table_last_lookup
14544 && (file_name == file_table_last_lookup->filename
14545 || strcmp (file_table_last_lookup->filename, file_name) == 0))
14546 return file_table_last_lookup;
14547
14548 /* Didn't match the previous lookup, search the table. */
14549 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (file_table, file_name,
14550 htab_hash_string (file_name), INSERT);
14551 if (*slot)
14552 return *slot;
14553
14554 created = ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct dwarf_file_data));
14555 created->filename = file_name;
14556 created->emitted_number = 0;
14557 *slot = created;
14558 return created;
14559 }
14560
14561 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
14562 internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
14563 a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet. The file table
14564 numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
14565 types, which may include filenames. */
14566
14567 static int
14568 maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data * fd)
14569 {
14570 if (! fd->emitted_number)
14571 {
14572 if (last_emitted_file)
14573 fd->emitted_number = last_emitted_file->emitted_number + 1;
14574 else
14575 fd->emitted_number = 1;
14576 last_emitted_file = fd;
14577
14578 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
14579 {
14580 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ", fd->emitted_number);
14581 output_quoted_string (asm_out_file,
14582 remap_debug_filename (fd->filename));
14583 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
14584 }
14585 }
14586
14587 return fd->emitted_number;
14588 }
14589
14590 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location. We
14591 use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
14592 our lookup table. */
14593
14594 static void
14595 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx loc_note)
14596 {
14597 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
14598 struct var_loc_node *newloc;
14599 rtx prev_insn;
14600 static rtx last_insn;
14601 static const char *last_label;
14602 tree decl;
14603
14604 if (!DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
14605 return;
14606 prev_insn = PREV_INSN (loc_note);
14607
14608 newloc = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct var_loc_node));
14609 /* If the insn we processed last time is the previous insn
14610 and it is also a var location note, use the label we emitted
14611 last time. */
14612 if (last_insn != NULL_RTX
14613 && last_insn == prev_insn
14614 && NOTE_P (prev_insn)
14615 && NOTE_KIND (prev_insn) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION)
14616 {
14617 newloc->label = last_label;
14618 }
14619 else
14620 {
14621 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
14622 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
14623 loclabel_num++;
14624 newloc->label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
14625 }
14626 newloc->var_loc_note = loc_note;
14627 newloc->next = NULL;
14628
14629 if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
14630 newloc->section_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
14631 else
14632 newloc->section_label = text_section_label;
14633
14634 last_insn = loc_note;
14635 last_label = newloc->label;
14636 decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
14637 add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, newloc);
14638 }
14639
14640 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
14641 function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
14642 declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
14643 that hook is called. Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here. */
14644
14645 static void
14646 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
14647 {
14648 htab_empty (decl_loc_table);
14649
14650 if (function_section (fun) != text_section)
14651 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
14652
14653 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
14654 }
14655
14656 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
14657 and record information relating to this source line, in
14658 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
14659
14660 static void
14661 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, const char *filename)
14662 {
14663 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL
14664 && line != 0)
14665 {
14666 int file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
14667
14668 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
14669
14670 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
14671 if (flag_debug_asm)
14672 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
14673 filename, line);
14674
14675 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
14676 {
14677 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
14678 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.loc %d %d 0\n", file_num, line);
14679
14680 /* Indicate that line number info exists. */
14681 line_info_table_in_use++;
14682 }
14683 else if (function_section (current_function_decl) != text_section)
14684 {
14685 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info;
14686 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file,
14687 SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
14688 separate_line_info_table_in_use);
14689
14690 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
14691 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use
14692 == separate_line_info_table_allocated)
14693 {
14694 separate_line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
14695 separate_line_info_table
14696 = ggc_realloc (separate_line_info_table,
14697 separate_line_info_table_allocated
14698 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry));
14699 memset (separate_line_info_table
14700 + separate_line_info_table_in_use,
14701 0,
14702 (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
14703 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry)));
14704 }
14705
14706 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
14707 line_info
14708 = &separate_line_info_table[separate_line_info_table_in_use++];
14709 line_info->dw_file_num = file_num;
14710 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
14711 line_info->function = current_function_funcdef_no;
14712 }
14713 else
14714 {
14715 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
14716
14717 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL,
14718 line_info_table_in_use);
14719
14720 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
14721 if (line_info_table_in_use == line_info_table_allocated)
14722 {
14723 line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
14724 line_info_table
14725 = ggc_realloc (line_info_table,
14726 (line_info_table_allocated
14727 * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry)));
14728 memset (line_info_table + line_info_table_in_use, 0,
14729 LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
14730 }
14731
14732 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
14733 line_info = &line_info_table[line_info_table_in_use++];
14734 line_info->dw_file_num = file_num;
14735 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
14736 }
14737 }
14738 }
14739
14740 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
14741
14742 static void
14743 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
14744 {
14745 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
14746 {
14747 /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes. */
14748 dw_die_ref bincl_die;
14749
14750 bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
14751 add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, remap_debug_filename (filename));
14752 }
14753
14754 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14755 {
14756 int file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
14757
14758 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
14759 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
14760 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "Included from line number %d",
14761 lineno);
14762
14763 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (file_num, "file %s", filename);
14764 }
14765 }
14766
14767 /* Record the end of a source file. */
14768
14769 static void
14770 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
14771 {
14772 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
14773 /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes. */
14774 new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
14775
14776 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14777 {
14778 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
14779 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
14780 }
14781 }
14782
14783 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
14784 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
14785 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
14786
14787 static void
14788 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
14789 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
14790 {
14791 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14792 {
14793 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
14794 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_define, "Define macro");
14795 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
14796 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
14797 }
14798 }
14799
14800 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
14801 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
14802 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
14803
14804 static void
14805 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
14806 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
14807 {
14808 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14809 {
14810 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
14811 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_undef, "Undefine macro");
14812 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
14813 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
14814 }
14815 }
14816
14817 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
14818
14819 static void
14820 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
14821 {
14822 /* Allocate the file_table. */
14823 file_table = htab_create_ggc (50, file_table_hash,
14824 file_table_eq, NULL);
14825
14826 /* Allocate the decl_die_table. */
14827 decl_die_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_die_table_hash,
14828 decl_die_table_eq, NULL);
14829
14830 /* Allocate the decl_loc_table. */
14831 decl_loc_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_loc_table_hash,
14832 decl_loc_table_eq, NULL);
14833
14834 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
14835 decl_scope_table = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 256);
14836
14837 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
14838 abbrev_die_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT
14839 * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
14840 abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
14841 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
14842 abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
14843
14844 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the line_info_table. */
14845 line_info_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
14846 * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
14847 line_info_table_allocated = LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
14848
14849 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
14850 line_info_table_in_use = 1;
14851
14852 /* Allocate the pubtypes and pubnames vectors. */
14853 pubname_table = VEC_alloc (pubname_entry, gc, 32);
14854 pubtype_table = VEC_alloc (pubname_entry, gc, 32);
14855
14856 /* Generate the initial DIE for the .debug section. Note that the (string)
14857 value given in the DW_AT_name attribute of the DW_TAG_compile_unit DIE
14858 will (typically) be a relative pathname and that this pathname should be
14859 taken as being relative to the directory from which the compiler was
14860 invoked when the given (base) source file was compiled. We will fill
14861 in this value in dwarf2out_finish. */
14862 comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
14863
14864 incomplete_types = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 64);
14865
14866 used_rtx_array = VEC_alloc (rtx, gc, 32);
14867
14868 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
14869 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14870 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
14871 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14872 debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
14873 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14874 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION,
14875 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14876 debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
14877 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14878 debug_loc_section = get_section (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
14879 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14880 debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
14881 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14882 #ifdef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
14883 debug_pubtypes_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION,
14884 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14885 #endif
14886 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
14887 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
14888 debug_ranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
14889 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14890 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
14891 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14892
14893 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
14894 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
14895 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14896 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14897 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
14898 COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14899 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
14900
14901 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
14902 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14903 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
14904 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14905 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
14906 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14907 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
14908 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
14909 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
14910 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
14911 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
14912 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
14913
14914 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14915 {
14916 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
14917 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
14918 DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14919 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
14920 }
14921
14922 switch_to_section (text_section);
14923 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
14924 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
14925 {
14926 cold_text_section = unlikely_text_section ();
14927 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
14928 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
14929 }
14930 }
14931
14932 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
14933 ht_forall. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
14934
14935 static int
14936 output_indirect_string (void **h, void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
14937 {
14938 struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *h;
14939
14940 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
14941 {
14942 switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
14943 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
14944 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
14945 }
14946
14947 return 1;
14948 }
14949
14950 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
14951 /* Verify that all marks are clear. */
14952
14953 static void
14954 verify_marks_clear (dw_die_ref die)
14955 {
14956 dw_die_ref c;
14957
14958 gcc_assert (! die->die_mark);
14959 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, verify_marks_clear (c));
14960 }
14961 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
14962
14963 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
14964 Be cool if the mark isn't set. */
14965
14966 static void
14967 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
14968 {
14969 dw_die_ref c;
14970
14971 if (die->die_mark)
14972 die->die_mark = 0;
14973 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unmark_dies (c));
14974 }
14975
14976 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
14977 it references as attributes and mark them as used. */
14978
14979 static void
14980 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
14981 {
14982 dw_attr_ref a;
14983 unsigned ix;
14984
14985 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
14986 {
14987 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
14988 {
14989 /* A reference to another DIE.
14990 Make sure that it will get emitted. */
14991 prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
14992 }
14993 /* Set the string's refcount to 0 so that prune_unused_types_mark
14994 accounts properly for it. */
14995 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
14996 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount = 0;
14997 }
14998 }
14999
15000
15001 /* Mark DIE as being used. If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
15002 to DIE's children. */
15003
15004 static void
15005 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
15006 {
15007 dw_die_ref c;
15008
15009 if (die->die_mark == 0)
15010 {
15011 /* We haven't done this node yet. Mark it as used. */
15012 die->die_mark = 1;
15013
15014 /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
15015 (But we don't want to mark our parents' kids due to this.) */
15016 if (die->die_parent)
15017 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent, 0);
15018
15019 /* Mark any referenced nodes. */
15020 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
15021
15022 /* If this node is a specification,
15023 also mark the definition, if it exists. */
15024 if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
15025 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
15026 }
15027
15028 if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
15029 {
15030 /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
15031 Remember that we've walked the kids. */
15032 die->die_mark = 2;
15033
15034 /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
15035 kids get marked, even if they're types. */
15036 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type)
15037 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1));
15038 else
15039 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
15040 }
15041 }
15042
15043
15044 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use. */
15045
15046 static void
15047 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
15048 {
15049 dw_die_ref c;
15050
15051 /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked. */
15052 if (die->die_mark)
15053 return;
15054
15055 switch (die->die_tag)
15056 {
15057 case DW_TAG_const_type:
15058 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
15059 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
15060 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
15061 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
15062 case DW_TAG_typedef:
15063 case DW_TAG_array_type:
15064 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
15065 case DW_TAG_union_type:
15066 case DW_TAG_class_type:
15067 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
15068 case DW_TAG_friend:
15069 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
15070 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
15071 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
15072 case DW_TAG_string_type:
15073 case DW_TAG_set_type:
15074 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
15075 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
15076 case DW_TAG_file_type:
15077 if (die->die_perennial_p)
15078 break;
15079
15080 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
15081 return;
15082
15083 default:
15084 /* Mark everything else. */
15085 break;
15086 }
15087
15088 die->die_mark = 1;
15089
15090 /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here. */
15091 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
15092
15093 /* Mark children. */
15094 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
15095 }
15096
15097 /* Increment the string counts on strings referred to from DIE's
15098 attributes. */
15099
15100 static void
15101 prune_unused_types_update_strings (dw_die_ref die)
15102 {
15103 dw_attr_ref a;
15104 unsigned ix;
15105
15106 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
15107 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
15108 {
15109 struct indirect_string_node *s = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
15110 s->refcount++;
15111 /* Avoid unnecessarily putting strings that are used less than
15112 twice in the hash table. */
15113 if (s->refcount
15114 == ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) ? 1 : 2))
15115 {
15116 void ** slot;
15117 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, s->str,
15118 htab_hash_string (s->str),
15119 INSERT);
15120 gcc_assert (*slot == NULL);
15121 *slot = s;
15122 }
15123 }
15124 }
15125
15126 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked. */
15127
15128 static void
15129 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
15130 {
15131 dw_die_ref c;
15132
15133 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
15134 prune_unused_types_update_strings (die);
15135
15136 if (! die->die_child)
15137 return;
15138
15139 c = die->die_child;
15140 do {
15141 dw_die_ref prev = c;
15142 for (c = c->die_sib; ! c->die_mark; c = c->die_sib)
15143 if (c == die->die_child)
15144 {
15145 /* No marked children between 'prev' and the end of the list. */
15146 if (prev == c)
15147 /* No marked children at all. */
15148 die->die_child = NULL;
15149 else
15150 {
15151 prev->die_sib = c->die_sib;
15152 die->die_child = prev;
15153 }
15154 return;
15155 }
15156
15157 if (c != prev->die_sib)
15158 prev->die_sib = c;
15159 prune_unused_types_prune (c);
15160 } while (c != die->die_child);
15161 }
15162
15163
15164 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use. */
15165
15166 static void
15167 prune_unused_types (void)
15168 {
15169 unsigned int i;
15170 limbo_die_node *node;
15171 pubname_ref pub;
15172
15173 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
15174 /* All the marks should already be clear. */
15175 verify_marks_clear (comp_unit_die);
15176 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
15177 verify_marks_clear (node->die);
15178 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
15179
15180 /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used. */
15181 prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die);
15182 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
15183 prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
15184
15185 /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the
15186 pubname_table or arange_table. */
15187 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, pubname_table, i, pub); i++)
15188 prune_unused_types_mark (pub->die, 1);
15189 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
15190 prune_unused_types_mark (arange_table[i], 1);
15191
15192 /* Get rid of nodes that aren't marked; and update the string counts. */
15193 if (debug_str_hash)
15194 htab_empty (debug_str_hash);
15195 prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die);
15196 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
15197 prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
15198
15199 /* Leave the marks clear. */
15200 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die);
15201 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
15202 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
15203 }
15204
15205 /* Set the parameter to true if there are any relative pathnames in
15206 the file table. */
15207 static int
15208 file_table_relative_p (void ** slot, void *param)
15209 {
15210 bool *p = param;
15211 struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
15212 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (d->filename))
15213 {
15214 *p = true;
15215 return 0;
15216 }
15217 return 1;
15218 }
15219
15220 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
15221 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
15222
15223 static void
15224 dwarf2out_finish (const char *filename)
15225 {
15226 limbo_die_node *node, *next_node;
15227 dw_die_ref die = 0;
15228
15229 /* Add the name for the main input file now. We delayed this from
15230 dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH. */
15231 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die, remap_debug_filename (filename));
15232 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename))
15233 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
15234 else if (get_AT (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_comp_dir) == NULL)
15235 {
15236 bool p = false;
15237 htab_traverse (file_table, file_table_relative_p, &p);
15238 if (p)
15239 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
15240 }
15241
15242 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
15243 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
15244 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
15245 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
15246 instance. */
15247 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = next_node)
15248 {
15249 next_node = node->next;
15250 die = node->die;
15251
15252 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
15253 {
15254 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
15255
15256 if (origin)
15257 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
15258 else if (die == comp_unit_die)
15259 ;
15260 else if (errorcount > 0 || sorrycount > 0)
15261 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
15262 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
15263 else
15264 {
15265 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
15266 nested function can be optimized away, which results
15267 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
15268 with the return type of that nested function. Force
15269 this to be a child of the containing function.
15270
15271 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
15272 inlined and optimized out. In that case we are lost and
15273 assign the empty child. This should not be big issue as
15274 the function is likely unreachable too. */
15275 tree context = NULL_TREE;
15276
15277 gcc_assert (node->created_for);
15278
15279 if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
15280 context = DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
15281 else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
15282 context = TYPE_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
15283
15284 gcc_assert (context
15285 && (TREE_CODE (context) == FUNCTION_DECL
15286 || TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL));
15287
15288 origin = lookup_decl_die (context);
15289 if (origin)
15290 add_child_die (origin, die);
15291 else
15292 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
15293 }
15294 }
15295 }
15296
15297 limbo_die_list = NULL;
15298
15299 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
15300 emit full debugging info for them. */
15301 retry_incomplete_types ();
15302
15303 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
15304 prune_unused_types ();
15305
15306 /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
15307 They will go into limbo_die_list. */
15308 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
15309 break_out_includes (comp_unit_die);
15310
15311 /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
15312 that have children. */
15313 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die);
15314 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
15315 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
15316
15317 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
15318 switch_to_section (text_section);
15319 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
15320 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
15321 {
15322 switch_to_section (unlikely_text_section ());
15323 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
15324 }
15325
15326 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
15327 in .text. */
15328 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
15329 {
15330 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, text_section_label);
15331 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_high_pc, text_end_label);
15332 }
15333
15334 else
15335 {
15336 unsigned fde_idx = 0;
15337
15338 /* We need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
15339 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become
15340 absolute. Historically, we've emitted the unexpected
15341 DW_AT_entry_pc instead of DW_AT_low_pc for this purpose.
15342 Emit both to give time for other tools to adapt. */
15343 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, const0_rtx);
15344 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx);
15345
15346 add_AT_range_list (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_ranges,
15347 add_ranges_by_labels (text_section_label,
15348 text_end_label));
15349 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
15350 add_ranges_by_labels (cold_text_section_label,
15351 cold_end_label);
15352
15353 for (fde_idx = 0; fde_idx < fde_table_in_use; fde_idx++)
15354 {
15355 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_idx];
15356
15357 if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
15358 {
15359 add_ranges_by_labels (fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
15360 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label);
15361 add_ranges_by_labels (fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
15362 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label);
15363 }
15364 else
15365 add_ranges_by_labels (fde->dw_fde_begin,
15366 fde->dw_fde_end);
15367 }
15368
15369 add_ranges (NULL);
15370 }
15371
15372 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
15373 if (have_location_lists)
15374 {
15375 /* Output the location lists info. */
15376 switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
15377 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label,
15378 DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
15379 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
15380 output_location_lists (die);
15381 }
15382
15383 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
15384 add_AT_lineptr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
15385 debug_line_section_label);
15386
15387 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
15388 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_macro_info, macinfo_section_label);
15389
15390 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
15391 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
15392 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
15393 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0);
15394
15395 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die, 0);
15396
15397 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
15398 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
15399 output_abbrev_section ();
15400
15401 /* Output public names table if necessary. */
15402 if (!VEC_empty (pubname_entry, pubname_table))
15403 {
15404 switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
15405 output_pubnames (pubname_table);
15406 }
15407
15408 #ifdef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
15409 /* Output public types table if necessary. */
15410 if (!VEC_empty (pubname_entry, pubtype_table))
15411 {
15412 switch_to_section (debug_pubtypes_section);
15413 output_pubnames (pubtype_table);
15414 }
15415 #endif
15416
15417 /* Output the address range information. We only put functions in the arange
15418 table, so don't write it out if we don't have any. */
15419 if (fde_table_in_use)
15420 {
15421 switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
15422 output_aranges ();
15423 }
15424
15425 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
15426 if (ranges_table_in_use)
15427 {
15428 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
15429 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
15430 output_ranges ();
15431 }
15432
15433 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
15434 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
15435 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
15436 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
15437 examining the file. This is done late so that any filenames
15438 used by the debug_info section are marked as 'used'. */
15439 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
15440 {
15441 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
15442 output_line_info ();
15443 }
15444
15445 /* Have to end the macro section. */
15446 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
15447 {
15448 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
15449 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
15450 }
15451
15452 /* If we emitted any DW_FORM_strp form attribute, output the string
15453 table too. */
15454 if (debug_str_hash)
15455 htab_traverse (debug_str_hash, output_indirect_string, NULL);
15456 }
15457 #else
15458
15459 /* This should never be used, but its address is needed for comparisons. */
15460 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks;
15461
15462 #endif /* DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO */
15463
15464 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"